1#ifndef __LINUX_NL80211_H
2#define __LINUX_NL80211_H
3/*
4 * 802.11 netlink interface public header
5 *
6 * Copyright 2006-2010 Johannes Berg <johannes@sipsolutions.net>
7 * Copyright 2008 Michael Wu <flamingice@sourmilk.net>
8 * Copyright 2008 Luis Carlos Cobo <luisca@cozybit.com>
9 * Copyright 2008 Michael Buesch <m@bues.ch>
10 * Copyright 2008, 2009 Luis R. Rodriguez <lrodriguez@atheros.com>
11 * Copyright 2008 Jouni Malinen <jouni.malinen@atheros.com>
12 * Copyright 2008 Colin McCabe <colin@cozybit.com>
13 * Copyright 2015-2017	Intel Deutschland GmbH
14 * Copyright (C) 2018-2020 Intel Corporation
15 *
16 * Permission to use, copy, modify, and/or distribute this software for any
17 * purpose with or without fee is hereby granted, provided that the above
18 * copyright notice and this permission notice appear in all copies.
19 *
20 * THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS" AND THE AUTHOR DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES
21 * WITH REGARD TO THIS SOFTWARE INCLUDING ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF
22 * MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHOR BE LIABLE FOR
23 * ANY SPECIAL, DIRECT, INDIRECT, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR ANY DAMAGES
24 * WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN AN
25 * ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING OUT OF
26 * OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE.
27 *
28 */
29
30/*
31 * This header file defines the userspace API to the wireless stack. Please
32 * be careful not to break things - i.e. don't move anything around or so
33 * unless you can demonstrate that it breaks neither API nor ABI.
34 *
35 * Additions to the API should be accompanied by actual implementations in
36 * an upstream driver, so that example implementations exist in case there
37 * are ever concerns about the precise semantics of the API or changes are
38 * needed, and to ensure that code for dead (no longer implemented) API
39 * can actually be identified and removed.
40 * Nonetheless, semantics should also be documented carefully in this file.
41 */
42
43#include <linux/types.h>
44
45#define NL80211_GENL_NAME "nl80211"
46
47#define NL80211_MULTICAST_GROUP_CONFIG		"config"
48#define NL80211_MULTICAST_GROUP_SCAN		"scan"
49#define NL80211_MULTICAST_GROUP_REG		"regulatory"
50#define NL80211_MULTICAST_GROUP_MLME		"mlme"
51#define NL80211_MULTICAST_GROUP_VENDOR		"vendor"
52#define NL80211_MULTICAST_GROUP_NAN		"nan"
53#define NL80211_MULTICAST_GROUP_TESTMODE	"testmode"
54
55#define NL80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_MIN	4
56#define NL80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_MAX	15
57#define NL80211_EDMG_CHANNELS_MIN	1
58#define NL80211_EDMG_CHANNELS_MAX	0x3c /* 0b00111100 */
59
60/**
61 * DOC: Station handling
62 *
63 * Stations are added per interface, but a special case exists with VLAN
64 * interfaces. When a station is bound to an AP interface, it may be moved
65 * into a VLAN identified by a VLAN interface index (%NL80211_ATTR_STA_VLAN).
66 * The station is still assumed to belong to the AP interface it was added
67 * to.
68 *
69 * Station handling varies per interface type and depending on the driver's
70 * capabilities.
71 *
72 * For drivers supporting TDLS with external setup (WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_TDLS
73 * and WIPHY_FLAG_TDLS_EXTERNAL_SETUP), the station lifetime is as follows:
74 *  - a setup station entry is added, not yet authorized, without any rate
75 *    or capability information, this just exists to avoid race conditions
76 *  - when the TDLS setup is done, a single NL80211_CMD_SET_STATION is valid
77 *    to add rate and capability information to the station and at the same
78 *    time mark it authorized.
79 *  - %NL80211_TDLS_ENABLE_LINK is then used
80 *  - after this, the only valid operation is to remove it by tearing down
81 *    the TDLS link (%NL80211_TDLS_DISABLE_LINK)
82 *
83 * TODO: need more info for other interface types
84 */
85
86/**
87 * DOC: Frame transmission/registration support
88 *
89 * Frame transmission and registration support exists to allow userspace
90 * management entities such as wpa_supplicant react to management frames
91 * that are not being handled by the kernel. This includes, for example,
92 * certain classes of action frames that cannot be handled in the kernel
93 * for various reasons.
94 *
95 * Frame registration is done on a per-interface basis and registrations
96 * cannot be removed other than by closing the socket. It is possible to
97 * specify a registration filter to register, for example, only for a
98 * certain type of action frame. In particular with action frames, those
99 * that userspace registers for will not be returned as unhandled by the
100 * driver, so that the registered application has to take responsibility
101 * for doing that.
102 *
103 * The type of frame that can be registered for is also dependent on the
104 * driver and interface type. The frame types are advertised in wiphy
105 * attributes so applications know what to expect.
106 *
107 * NOTE: When an interface changes type while registrations are active,
108 *       these registrations are ignored until the interface type is
109 *       changed again. This means that changing the interface type can
110 *       lead to a situation that couldn't otherwise be produced, but
111 *       any such registrations will be dormant in the sense that they
112 *       will not be serviced, i.e. they will not receive any frames.
113 *
114 * Frame transmission allows userspace to send for example the required
115 * responses to action frames. It is subject to some sanity checking,
116 * but many frames can be transmitted. When a frame was transmitted, its
117 * status is indicated to the sending socket.
118 *
119 * For more technical details, see the corresponding command descriptions
120 * below.
121 */
122
123/**
124 * DOC: Virtual interface / concurrency capabilities
125 *
126 * Some devices are able to operate with virtual MACs, they can have
127 * more than one virtual interface. The capability handling for this
128 * is a bit complex though, as there may be a number of restrictions
129 * on the types of concurrency that are supported.
130 *
131 * To start with, each device supports the interface types listed in
132 * the %NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORTED_IFTYPES attribute, but by listing the
133 * types there no concurrency is implied.
134 *
135 * Once concurrency is desired, more attributes must be observed:
136 * To start with, since some interface types are purely managed in
137 * software, like the AP-VLAN type in mac80211 for example, there's
138 * an additional list of these, they can be added at any time and
139 * are only restricted by some semantic restrictions (e.g. AP-VLAN
140 * cannot be added without a corresponding AP interface). This list
141 * is exported in the %NL80211_ATTR_SOFTWARE_IFTYPES attribute.
142 *
143 * Further, the list of supported combinations is exported. This is
144 * in the %NL80211_ATTR_INTERFACE_COMBINATIONS attribute. Basically,
145 * it exports a list of "groups", and at any point in time the
146 * interfaces that are currently active must fall into any one of
147 * the advertised groups. Within each group, there are restrictions
148 * on the number of interfaces of different types that are supported
149 * and also the number of different channels, along with potentially
150 * some other restrictions. See &enum nl80211_if_combination_attrs.
151 *
152 * All together, these attributes define the concurrency of virtual
153 * interfaces that a given device supports.
154 */
155
156/**
157 * DOC: packet coalesce support
158 *
159 * In most cases, host that receives IPv4 and IPv6 multicast/broadcast
160 * packets does not do anything with these packets. Therefore the
161 * reception of these unwanted packets causes unnecessary processing
162 * and power consumption.
163 *
164 * Packet coalesce feature helps to reduce number of received interrupts
165 * to host by buffering these packets in firmware/hardware for some
166 * predefined time. Received interrupt will be generated when one of the
167 * following events occur.
168 * a) Expiration of hardware timer whose expiration time is set to maximum
169 * coalescing delay of matching coalesce rule.
170 * b) Coalescing buffer in hardware reaches it's limit.
171 * c) Packet doesn't match any of the configured coalesce rules.
172 *
173 * User needs to configure following parameters for creating a coalesce
174 * rule.
175 * a) Maximum coalescing delay
176 * b) List of packet patterns which needs to be matched
177 * c) Condition for coalescence. pattern 'match' or 'no match'
178 * Multiple such rules can be created.
179 */
180
181/**
182 * DOC: WPA/WPA2 EAPOL handshake offload
183 *
184 * By setting @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_STA_PSK flag drivers
185 * can indicate they support offloading EAPOL handshakes for WPA/WPA2
186 * preshared key authentication in station mode. In %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT
187 * the preshared key should be specified using %NL80211_ATTR_PMK. Drivers
188 * supporting this offload may reject the %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT when no
189 * preshared key material is provided, for example when that driver does
190 * not support setting the temporal keys through %NL80211_CMD_NEW_KEY.
191 *
192 * Similarly @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_STA_1X flag can be
193 * set by drivers indicating offload support of the PTK/GTK EAPOL
194 * handshakes during 802.1X authentication in station mode. In order to
195 * use the offload the %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT should have
196 * %NL80211_ATTR_WANT_1X_4WAY_HS attribute flag. Drivers supporting this
197 * offload may reject the %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT when the attribute flag is
198 * not present.
199 *
200 * By setting @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_AP_PSK flag drivers
201 * can indicate they support offloading EAPOL handshakes for WPA/WPA2
202 * preshared key authentication in AP mode. In %NL80211_CMD_START_AP
203 * the preshared key should be specified using %NL80211_ATTR_PMK. Drivers
204 * supporting this offload may reject the %NL80211_CMD_START_AP when no
205 * preshared key material is provided, for example when that driver does
206 * not support setting the temporal keys through %NL80211_CMD_NEW_KEY.
207 *
208 * For 802.1X the PMK or PMK-R0 are set by providing %NL80211_ATTR_PMK
209 * using %NL80211_CMD_SET_PMK. For offloaded FT support also
210 * %NL80211_ATTR_PMKR0_NAME must be provided.
211 */
212
213/**
214 * DOC: FILS shared key authentication offload
215 *
216 * FILS shared key authentication offload can be advertized by drivers by
217 * setting @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_SK_OFFLOAD flag. The drivers that support
218 * FILS shared key authentication offload should be able to construct the
219 * authentication and association frames for FILS shared key authentication and
220 * eventually do a key derivation as per IEEE 802.11ai. The below additional
221 * parameters should be given to driver in %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT and/or in
222 * %NL80211_CMD_UPDATE_CONNECT_PARAMS.
223 *	%NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_USERNAME - used to construct keyname_nai
224 *	%NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_REALM - used to construct keyname_nai
225 *	%NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_NEXT_SEQ_NUM - used to construct erp message
226 *	%NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_RRK - used to generate the rIK and rMSK
227 * rIK should be used to generate an authentication tag on the ERP message and
228 * rMSK should be used to derive a PMKSA.
229 * rIK, rMSK should be generated and keyname_nai, sequence number should be used
230 * as specified in IETF RFC 6696.
231 *
232 * When FILS shared key authentication is completed, driver needs to provide the
233 * below additional parameters to userspace, which can be either after setting
234 * up a connection or after roaming.
235 *	%NL80211_ATTR_FILS_KEK - used for key renewal
236 *	%NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_NEXT_SEQ_NUM - used in further EAP-RP exchanges
237 *	%NL80211_ATTR_PMKID - used to identify the PMKSA used/generated
238 *	%Nl80211_ATTR_PMK - used to update PMKSA cache in userspace
239 * The PMKSA can be maintained in userspace persistently so that it can be used
240 * later after reboots or wifi turn off/on also.
241 *
242 * %NL80211_ATTR_FILS_CACHE_ID is the cache identifier advertized by a FILS
243 * capable AP supporting PMK caching. It specifies the scope within which the
244 * PMKSAs are cached in an ESS. %NL80211_CMD_SET_PMKSA and
245 * %NL80211_CMD_DEL_PMKSA are enhanced to allow support for PMKSA caching based
246 * on FILS cache identifier. Additionally %NL80211_ATTR_PMK is used with
247 * %NL80211_SET_PMKSA to specify the PMK corresponding to a PMKSA for driver to
248 * use in a FILS shared key connection with PMKSA caching.
249 */
250
251/**
252 * DOC: SAE authentication offload
253 *
254 * By setting @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SAE_OFFLOAD flag drivers can indicate they
255 * support offloading SAE authentication for WPA3-Personal networks in station
256 * mode. Similarly @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SAE_OFFLOAD_AP flag can be set by
257 * drivers indicating the offload support in AP mode.
258 *
259 * The password for SAE should be specified using %NL80211_ATTR_SAE_PASSWORD in
260 * %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT and %NL80211_CMD_START_AP for station and AP mode
261 * respectively.
262 */
263
264/**
265 * DOC: VLAN offload support for setting group keys and binding STAs to VLANs
266 *
267 * By setting @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_VLAN_OFFLOAD flag drivers can indicate they
268 * support offloading VLAN functionality in a manner where the driver exposes a
269 * single netdev that uses VLAN tagged frames and separate VLAN-specific netdevs
270 * can then be added using RTM_NEWLINK/IFLA_VLAN_ID similarly to the Ethernet
271 * case. Frames received from stations that are not assigned to any VLAN are
272 * delivered on the main netdev and frames to such stations can be sent through
273 * that main netdev.
274 *
275 * %NL80211_CMD_NEW_KEY (for group keys), %NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION, and
276 * %NL80211_CMD_SET_STATION will optionally specify vlan_id using
277 * %NL80211_ATTR_VLAN_ID.
278 */
279
280/**
281 * DOC: TID configuration
282 *
283 * TID config support can be checked in the %NL80211_ATTR_TID_CONFIG
284 * attribute given in wiphy capabilities.
285 *
286 * The necessary configuration parameters are mentioned in
287 * &enum nl80211_tid_config_attr and it will be passed to the
288 * %NL80211_CMD_SET_TID_CONFIG command in %NL80211_ATTR_TID_CONFIG.
289 *
290 * If the configuration needs to be applied for specific peer then the MAC
291 * address of the peer needs to be passed in %NL80211_ATTR_MAC, otherwise the
292 * configuration will be applied for all the connected peers in the vif except
293 * any peers that have peer specific configuration for the TID by default; if
294 * the %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_OVERRIDE flag is set, peer specific values
295 * will be overwritten.
296 *
297 * All this configuration is valid only for STA's current connection
298 * i.e. the configuration will be reset to default when the STA connects back
299 * after disconnection/roaming, and this configuration will be cleared when
300 * the interface goes down.
301 */
302
303/**
304 * enum nl80211_commands - supported nl80211 commands
305 *
306 * @NL80211_CMD_UNSPEC: unspecified command to catch errors
307 *
308 * @NL80211_CMD_GET_WIPHY: request information about a wiphy or dump request
309 *	to get a list of all present wiphys.
310 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_WIPHY: set wiphy parameters, needs %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY or
311 *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX; can be used to set %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_NAME,
312 *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TXQ_PARAMS, %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ,
313 *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_OFFSET (and the attributes determining the
314 *	channel width; this is used for setting monitor mode channel),
315 *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RETRY_SHORT, %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RETRY_LONG,
316 *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FRAG_THRESHOLD, and/or
317 *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RTS_THRESHOLD.  However, for setting the channel,
318 *	see %NL80211_CMD_SET_CHANNEL instead, the support here is for backward
319 *	compatibility only.
320 * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_WIPHY: Newly created wiphy, response to get request
321 *	or rename notification. Has attributes %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY and
322 *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_NAME.
323 * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_WIPHY: Wiphy deleted. Has attributes
324 *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY and %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_NAME.
325 *
326 * @NL80211_CMD_GET_INTERFACE: Request an interface's configuration;
327 *	either a dump request for all interfaces or a specific get with a
328 *	single %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX is supported.
329 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_INTERFACE: Set type of a virtual interface, requires
330 *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX and %NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE.
331 * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_INTERFACE: Newly created virtual interface or response
332 *	to %NL80211_CMD_GET_INTERFACE. Has %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX,
333 *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY and %NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE attributes. Can also
334 *	be sent from userspace to request creation of a new virtual interface,
335 *	then requires attributes %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY, %NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE and
336 *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFNAME.
337 * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_INTERFACE: Virtual interface was deleted, has attributes
338 *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX and %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY. Can also be sent from
339 *	userspace to request deletion of a virtual interface, then requires
340 *	attribute %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX.
341 *
342 * @NL80211_CMD_GET_KEY: Get sequence counter information for a key specified
343 *	by %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_IDX and/or %NL80211_ATTR_MAC.
344 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_KEY: Set key attributes %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT,
345 *	%NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT_MGMT, or %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_THRESHOLD.
346 * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_KEY: add a key with given %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DATA,
347 *	%NL80211_ATTR_KEY_IDX, %NL80211_ATTR_MAC, %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_CIPHER,
348 *	and %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_SEQ attributes.
349 * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_KEY: delete a key identified by %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_IDX
350 *	or %NL80211_ATTR_MAC.
351 *
352 * @NL80211_CMD_GET_BEACON: (not used)
353 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_BEACON: change the beacon on an access point interface
354 *	using the %NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_HEAD and %NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_TAIL
355 *	attributes. For drivers that generate the beacon and probe responses
356 *	internally, the following attributes must be provided: %NL80211_ATTR_IE,
357 *	%NL80211_ATTR_IE_PROBE_RESP and %NL80211_ATTR_IE_ASSOC_RESP.
358 * @NL80211_CMD_START_AP: Start AP operation on an AP interface, parameters
359 *	are like for %NL80211_CMD_SET_BEACON, and additionally parameters that
360 *	do not change are used, these include %NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_INTERVAL,
361 *	%NL80211_ATTR_DTIM_PERIOD, %NL80211_ATTR_SSID,
362 *	%NL80211_ATTR_HIDDEN_SSID, %NL80211_ATTR_CIPHERS_PAIRWISE,
363 *	%NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_GROUP, %NL80211_ATTR_WPA_VERSIONS,
364 *	%NL80211_ATTR_AKM_SUITES, %NL80211_ATTR_PRIVACY,
365 *	%NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_TYPE, %NL80211_ATTR_INACTIVITY_TIMEOUT,
366 *	%NL80211_ATTR_ACL_POLICY and %NL80211_ATTR_MAC_ADDRS.
367 *	The channel to use can be set on the interface or be given using the
368 *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ and %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_OFFSET, and the
369 *	attributes determining channel width.
370 * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_BEACON: old alias for %NL80211_CMD_START_AP
371 * @NL80211_CMD_STOP_AP: Stop AP operation on the given interface
372 * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_BEACON: old alias for %NL80211_CMD_STOP_AP
373 *
374 * @NL80211_CMD_GET_STATION: Get station attributes for station identified by
375 *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC on the interface identified by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX.
376 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_STATION: Set station attributes for station identified by
377 *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC on the interface identified by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX.
378 * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION: Add a station with given attributes to the
379 *	interface identified by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX.
380 * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_STATION: Remove a station identified by %NL80211_ATTR_MAC
381 *	or, if no MAC address given, all stations, on the interface identified
382 *	by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX. %NL80211_ATTR_MGMT_SUBTYPE and
383 *	%NL80211_ATTR_REASON_CODE can optionally be used to specify which type
384 *	of disconnection indication should be sent to the station
385 *	(Deauthentication or Disassociation frame and reason code for that
386 *	frame).
387 *
388 * @NL80211_CMD_GET_MPATH: Get mesh path attributes for mesh path to
389 * 	destination %NL80211_ATTR_MAC on the interface identified by
390 * 	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX.
391 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_MPATH:  Set mesh path attributes for mesh path to
392 * 	destination %NL80211_ATTR_MAC on the interface identified by
393 * 	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX.
394 * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_MPATH: Create a new mesh path for the destination given by
395 *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC via %NL80211_ATTR_MPATH_NEXT_HOP.
396 * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_MPATH: Delete a mesh path to the destination given by
397 *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC.
398 * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_PATH: Add a mesh path with given attributes to the
399 *	interface identified by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX.
400 * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_PATH: Remove a mesh path identified by %NL80211_ATTR_MAC
401 *	or, if no MAC address given, all mesh paths, on the interface identified
402 *	by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX.
403 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_BSS: Set BSS attributes for BSS identified by
404 *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX.
405 *
406 * @NL80211_CMD_GET_REG: ask the wireless core to send us its currently set
407 *	regulatory domain. If %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY is specified and the device
408 *	has a private regulatory domain, it will be returned. Otherwise, the
409 *	global regdomain will be returned.
410 *	A device will have a private regulatory domain if it uses the
411 *	regulatory_hint() API. Even when a private regdomain is used the channel
412 *	information will still be mended according to further hints from
413 *	the regulatory core to help with compliance. A dump version of this API
414 *	is now available which will returns the global regdomain as well as
415 *	all private regdomains of present wiphys (for those that have it).
416 *	If a wiphy is self-managed (%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_SELF_MANAGED_REG), then
417 *	its private regdomain is the only valid one for it. The regulatory
418 *	core is not used to help with compliance in this case.
419 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_REG: Set current regulatory domain. CRDA sends this command
420 *	after being queried by the kernel. CRDA replies by sending a regulatory
421 *	domain structure which consists of %NL80211_ATTR_REG_ALPHA set to our
422 *	current alpha2 if it found a match. It also provides
423 * 	NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULE_FLAGS, and a set of regulatory rules. Each
424 * 	regulatory rule is a nested set of attributes  given by
425 * 	%NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULE_FREQ_[START|END] and
426 * 	%NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_RANGE_MAX_BW with an attached power rule given by
427 * 	%NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULE_POWER_MAX_ANT_GAIN and
428 * 	%NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULE_POWER_MAX_EIRP.
429 * @NL80211_CMD_REQ_SET_REG: ask the wireless core to set the regulatory domain
430 * 	to the specified ISO/IEC 3166-1 alpha2 country code. The core will
431 * 	store this as a valid request and then query userspace for it.
432 *
433 * @NL80211_CMD_GET_MESH_CONFIG: Get mesh networking properties for the
434 *	interface identified by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX
435 *
436 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_MESH_CONFIG: Set mesh networking properties for the
437 *      interface identified by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX
438 *
439 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_MGMT_EXTRA_IE: Set extra IEs for management frames. The
440 *	interface is identified with %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX and the management
441 *	frame subtype with %NL80211_ATTR_MGMT_SUBTYPE. The extra IE data to be
442 *	added to the end of the specified management frame is specified with
443 *	%NL80211_ATTR_IE. If the command succeeds, the requested data will be
444 *	added to all specified management frames generated by
445 *	kernel/firmware/driver.
446 *	Note: This command has been removed and it is only reserved at this
447 *	point to avoid re-using existing command number. The functionality this
448 *	command was planned for has been provided with cleaner design with the
449 *	option to specify additional IEs in NL80211_CMD_TRIGGER_SCAN,
450 *	NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE, NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE,
451 *	NL80211_CMD_DEAUTHENTICATE, and NL80211_CMD_DISASSOCIATE.
452 *
453 * @NL80211_CMD_GET_SCAN: get scan results
454 * @NL80211_CMD_TRIGGER_SCAN: trigger a new scan with the given parameters
455 *	%NL80211_ATTR_TX_NO_CCK_RATE is used to decide whether to send the
456 *	probe requests at CCK rate or not. %NL80211_ATTR_BSSID can be used to
457 *	specify a BSSID to scan for; if not included, the wildcard BSSID will
458 *	be used.
459 * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_SCAN_RESULTS: scan notification (as a reply to
460 *	NL80211_CMD_GET_SCAN and on the "scan" multicast group)
461 * @NL80211_CMD_SCAN_ABORTED: scan was aborted, for unspecified reasons,
462 *	partial scan results may be available
463 *
464 * @NL80211_CMD_START_SCHED_SCAN: start a scheduled scan at certain
465 *	intervals and certain number of cycles, as specified by
466 *	%NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_PLANS. If %NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_PLANS is
467 *	not specified and only %NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_INTERVAL is specified,
468 *	scheduled scan will run in an infinite loop with the specified interval.
469 *	These attributes are mutually exculsive,
470 *	i.e. NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_INTERVAL must not be passed if
471 *	NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_PLANS is defined.
472 *	If for some reason scheduled scan is aborted by the driver, all scan
473 *	plans are canceled (including scan plans that did not start yet).
474 *	Like with normal scans, if SSIDs (%NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_SSIDS)
475 *	are passed, they are used in the probe requests.  For
476 *	broadcast, a broadcast SSID must be passed (ie. an empty
477 *	string).  If no SSID is passed, no probe requests are sent and
478 *	a passive scan is performed.  %NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQUENCIES,
479 *	if passed, define which channels should be scanned; if not
480 *	passed, all channels allowed for the current regulatory domain
481 *	are used.  Extra IEs can also be passed from the userspace by
482 *	using the %NL80211_ATTR_IE attribute.  The first cycle of the
483 *	scheduled scan can be delayed by %NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_DELAY
484 *	is supplied. If the device supports multiple concurrent scheduled
485 *	scans, it will allow such when the caller provides the flag attribute
486 *	%NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MULTI to indicate user-space support for it.
487 * @NL80211_CMD_STOP_SCHED_SCAN: stop a scheduled scan. Returns -ENOENT if
488 *	scheduled scan is not running. The caller may assume that as soon
489 *	as the call returns, it is safe to start a new scheduled scan again.
490 * @NL80211_CMD_SCHED_SCAN_RESULTS: indicates that there are scheduled scan
491 *	results available.
492 * @NL80211_CMD_SCHED_SCAN_STOPPED: indicates that the scheduled scan has
493 *	stopped.  The driver may issue this event at any time during a
494 *	scheduled scan.  One reason for stopping the scan is if the hardware
495 *	does not support starting an association or a normal scan while running
496 *	a scheduled scan.  This event is also sent when the
497 *	%NL80211_CMD_STOP_SCHED_SCAN command is received or when the interface
498 *	is brought down while a scheduled scan was running.
499 *
500 * @NL80211_CMD_GET_SURVEY: get survey resuls, e.g. channel occupation
501 *      or noise level
502 * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_SURVEY_RESULTS: survey data notification (as a reply to
503 *	NL80211_CMD_GET_SURVEY and on the "scan" multicast group)
504 *
505 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_PMKSA: Add a PMKSA cache entry using %NL80211_ATTR_MAC
506 *	(for the BSSID), %NL80211_ATTR_PMKID, and optionally %NL80211_ATTR_PMK
507 *	(PMK is used for PTKSA derivation in case of FILS shared key offload) or
508 *	using %NL80211_ATTR_SSID, %NL80211_ATTR_FILS_CACHE_ID,
509 *	%NL80211_ATTR_PMKID, and %NL80211_ATTR_PMK in case of FILS
510 *	authentication where %NL80211_ATTR_FILS_CACHE_ID is the identifier
511 *	advertized by a FILS capable AP identifying the scope of PMKSA in an
512 *	ESS.
513 * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_PMKSA: Delete a PMKSA cache entry, using %NL80211_ATTR_MAC
514 *	(for the BSSID) and %NL80211_ATTR_PMKID or using %NL80211_ATTR_SSID,
515 *	%NL80211_ATTR_FILS_CACHE_ID, and %NL80211_ATTR_PMKID in case of FILS
516 *	authentication.
517 * @NL80211_CMD_FLUSH_PMKSA: Flush all PMKSA cache entries.
518 *
519 * @NL80211_CMD_REG_CHANGE: indicates to userspace the regulatory domain
520 * 	has been changed and provides details of the request information
521 * 	that caused the change such as who initiated the regulatory request
522 * 	(%NL80211_ATTR_REG_INITIATOR), the wiphy_idx
523 * 	(%NL80211_ATTR_REG_ALPHA2) on which the request was made from if
524 * 	the initiator was %NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_COUNTRY_IE or
525 * 	%NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_DRIVER, the type of regulatory domain
526 * 	set (%NL80211_ATTR_REG_TYPE), if the type of regulatory domain is
527 * 	%NL80211_REG_TYPE_COUNTRY the alpha2 to which we have moved on
528 * 	to (%NL80211_ATTR_REG_ALPHA2).
529 * @NL80211_CMD_REG_BEACON_HINT: indicates to userspace that an AP beacon
530 * 	has been found while world roaming thus enabling active scan or
531 * 	any mode of operation that initiates TX (beacons) on a channel
532 * 	where we would not have been able to do either before. As an example
533 * 	if you are world roaming (regulatory domain set to world or if your
534 * 	driver is using a custom world roaming regulatory domain) and while
535 * 	doing a passive scan on the 5 GHz band you find an AP there (if not
536 * 	on a DFS channel) you will now be able to actively scan for that AP
537 * 	or use AP mode on your card on that same channel. Note that this will
538 * 	never be used for channels 1-11 on the 2 GHz band as they are always
539 * 	enabled world wide. This beacon hint is only sent if your device had
540 * 	either disabled active scanning or beaconing on a channel. We send to
541 * 	userspace the wiphy on which we removed a restriction from
542 * 	(%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY) and the channel on which this occurred
543 * 	before (%NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_BEFORE) and after (%NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_AFTER)
544 * 	the beacon hint was processed.
545 *
546 * @NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE: authentication request and notification.
547 *	This command is used both as a command (request to authenticate) and
548 *	as an event on the "mlme" multicast group indicating completion of the
549 *	authentication process.
550 *	When used as a command, %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX is used to identify the
551 *	interface. %NL80211_ATTR_MAC is used to specify PeerSTAAddress (and
552 *	BSSID in case of station mode). %NL80211_ATTR_SSID is used to specify
553 *	the SSID (mainly for association, but is included in authentication
554 *	request, too, to help BSS selection. %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ +
555 *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_OFFSET is used to specify the frequence of the
556 *	channel in MHz. %NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_TYPE is used to specify the
557 *	authentication type. %NL80211_ATTR_IE is used to define IEs
558 *	(VendorSpecificInfo, but also including RSN IE and FT IEs) to be added
559 *	to the frame.
560 *	When used as an event, this reports reception of an Authentication
561 *	frame in station and IBSS modes when the local MLME processed the
562 *	frame, i.e., it was for the local STA and was received in correct
563 *	state. This is similar to MLME-AUTHENTICATE.confirm primitive in the
564 *	MLME SAP interface (kernel providing MLME, userspace SME). The
565 *	included %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME attribute contains the management frame
566 *	(including both the header and frame body, but not FCS). This event is
567 *	also used to indicate if the authentication attempt timed out. In that
568 *	case the %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME attribute is replaced with a
569 *	%NL80211_ATTR_TIMED_OUT flag (and %NL80211_ATTR_MAC to indicate which
570 *	pending authentication timed out).
571 * @NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE: association request and notification; like
572 *	NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE but for Association and Reassociation
573 *	(similar to MLME-ASSOCIATE.request, MLME-REASSOCIATE.request,
574 *	MLME-ASSOCIATE.confirm or MLME-REASSOCIATE.confirm primitives). The
575 *	%NL80211_ATTR_PREV_BSSID attribute is used to specify whether the
576 *	request is for the initial association to an ESS (that attribute not
577 *	included) or for reassociation within the ESS (that attribute is
578 *	included).
579 * @NL80211_CMD_DEAUTHENTICATE: deauthentication request and notification; like
580 *	NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE but for Deauthentication frames (similar to
581 *	MLME-DEAUTHENTICATION.request and MLME-DEAUTHENTICATE.indication
582 *	primitives).
583 * @NL80211_CMD_DISASSOCIATE: disassociation request and notification; like
584 *	NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE but for Disassociation frames (similar to
585 *	MLME-DISASSOCIATE.request and MLME-DISASSOCIATE.indication primitives).
586 *
587 * @NL80211_CMD_MICHAEL_MIC_FAILURE: notification of a locally detected Michael
588 *	MIC (part of TKIP) failure; sent on the "mlme" multicast group; the
589 *	event includes %NL80211_ATTR_MAC to describe the source MAC address of
590 *	the frame with invalid MIC, %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_TYPE to show the key
591 *	type, %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_IDX to indicate the key identifier, and
592 *	%NL80211_ATTR_KEY_SEQ to indicate the TSC value of the frame; this
593 *	event matches with MLME-MICHAELMICFAILURE.indication() primitive
594 *
595 * @NL80211_CMD_JOIN_IBSS: Join a new IBSS -- given at least an SSID and a
596 *	FREQ attribute (for the initial frequency if no peer can be found)
597 *	and optionally a MAC (as BSSID) and FREQ_FIXED attribute if those
598 *	should be fixed rather than automatically determined. Can only be
599 *	executed on a network interface that is UP, and fixed BSSID/FREQ
600 *	may be rejected. Another optional parameter is the beacon interval,
601 *	given in the %NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_INTERVAL attribute, which if not
602 *	given defaults to 100 TU (102.4ms).
603 * @NL80211_CMD_LEAVE_IBSS: Leave the IBSS -- no special arguments, the IBSS is
604 *	determined by the network interface.
605 *
606 * @NL80211_CMD_TESTMODE: testmode command, takes a wiphy (or ifindex) attribute
607 *	to identify the device, and the TESTDATA blob attribute to pass through
608 *	to the driver.
609 *
610 * @NL80211_CMD_CONNECT: connection request and notification; this command
611 *	requests to connect to a specified network but without separating
612 *	auth and assoc steps. For this, you need to specify the SSID in a
613 *	%NL80211_ATTR_SSID attribute, and can optionally specify the association
614 *	IEs in %NL80211_ATTR_IE, %NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_TYPE,
615 *	%NL80211_ATTR_USE_MFP, %NL80211_ATTR_MAC, %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ,
616 *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_OFFSET, %NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT,
617 *	%NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_ETHERTYPE,
618 *	%NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_NO_ENCRYPT,
619 *	%NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_OVER_NL80211, %NL80211_ATTR_MAC_HINT, and
620 *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_HINT.
621 *	If included, %NL80211_ATTR_MAC and %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ are
622 *	restrictions on BSS selection, i.e., they effectively prevent roaming
623 *	within the ESS. %NL80211_ATTR_MAC_HINT and %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_HINT
624 *	can be included to provide a recommendation of the initial BSS while
625 *	allowing the driver to roam to other BSSes within the ESS and also to
626 *	ignore this recommendation if the indicated BSS is not ideal. Only one
627 *	set of BSSID,frequency parameters is used (i.e., either the enforcing
628 *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC,%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ or the less strict
629 *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC_HINT and %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_HINT).
630 *	Driver shall not modify the IEs specified through %NL80211_ATTR_IE if
631 *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC is included. However, if %NL80211_ATTR_MAC_HINT is
632 *	included, these IEs through %NL80211_ATTR_IE are specified by the user
633 *	space based on the best possible BSS selected. Thus, if the driver ends
634 *	up selecting a different BSS, it can modify these IEs accordingly (e.g.
635 *	userspace asks the driver to perform PMKSA caching with BSS1 and the
636 *	driver ends up selecting BSS2 with different PMKSA cache entry; RSNIE
637 *	has to get updated with the apt PMKID).
638 *	%NL80211_ATTR_PREV_BSSID can be used to request a reassociation within
639 *	the ESS in case the device is already associated and an association with
640 *	a different BSS is desired.
641 *	Background scan period can optionally be
642 *	specified in %NL80211_ATTR_BG_SCAN_PERIOD,
643 *	if not specified default background scan configuration
644 *	in driver is used and if period value is 0, bg scan will be disabled.
645 *	This attribute is ignored if driver does not support roam scan.
646 *	It is also sent as an event, with the BSSID and response IEs when the
647 *	connection is established or failed to be established. This can be
648 *	determined by the %NL80211_ATTR_STATUS_CODE attribute (0 = success,
649 *	non-zero = failure). If %NL80211_ATTR_TIMED_OUT is included in the
650 *	event, the connection attempt failed due to not being able to initiate
651 *	authentication/association or not receiving a response from the AP.
652 *	Non-zero %NL80211_ATTR_STATUS_CODE value is indicated in that case as
653 *	well to remain backwards compatible.
654 * @NL80211_CMD_ROAM: Notification indicating the card/driver roamed by itself.
655 *	When a security association was established on an 802.1X network using
656 *	fast transition, this event should be followed by an
657 *	%NL80211_CMD_PORT_AUTHORIZED event.
658 * @NL80211_CMD_DISCONNECT: drop a given connection; also used to notify
659 *	userspace that a connection was dropped by the AP or due to other
660 *	reasons, for this the %NL80211_ATTR_DISCONNECTED_BY_AP and
661 *	%NL80211_ATTR_REASON_CODE attributes are used.
662 *
663 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_WIPHY_NETNS: Set a wiphy's netns. Note that all devices
664 *	associated with this wiphy must be down and will follow.
665 *
666 * @NL80211_CMD_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL: Request to remain awake on the specified
667 *	channel for the specified amount of time. This can be used to do
668 *	off-channel operations like transmit a Public Action frame and wait for
669 *	a response while being associated to an AP on another channel.
670 *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX is used to specify which interface (and thus
671 *	radio) is used. %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ is used to specify the
672 *	frequency for the operation.
673 *	%NL80211_ATTR_DURATION is used to specify the duration in milliseconds
674 *	to remain on the channel. This command is also used as an event to
675 *	notify when the requested duration starts (it may take a while for the
676 *	driver to schedule this time due to other concurrent needs for the
677 *	radio).
678 *	When called, this operation returns a cookie (%NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE)
679 *	that will be included with any events pertaining to this request;
680 *	the cookie is also used to cancel the request.
681 * @NL80211_CMD_CANCEL_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL: This command can be used to cancel a
682 *	pending remain-on-channel duration if the desired operation has been
683 *	completed prior to expiration of the originally requested duration.
684 *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY or %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX is used to specify the
685 *	radio. The %NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE attribute must be given as well to
686 *	uniquely identify the request.
687 *	This command is also used as an event to notify when a requested
688 *	remain-on-channel duration has expired.
689 *
690 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_TX_BITRATE_MASK: Set the mask of rates to be used in TX
691 *	rate selection. %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX is used to specify the interface
692 *	and @NL80211_ATTR_TX_RATES the set of allowed rates.
693 *
694 * @NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_FRAME: Register for receiving certain mgmt frames
695 *	(via @NL80211_CMD_FRAME) for processing in userspace. This command
696 *	requires an interface index, a frame type attribute (optional for
697 *	backward compatibility reasons, if not given assumes action frames)
698 *	and a match attribute containing the first few bytes of the frame
699 *	that should match, e.g. a single byte for only a category match or
700 *	four bytes for vendor frames including the OUI. The registration
701 *	cannot be dropped, but is removed automatically when the netlink
702 *	socket is closed. Multiple registrations can be made.
703 *	The %NL80211_ATTR_RECEIVE_MULTICAST flag attribute can be given if
704 *	%NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MULTICAST_REGISTRATIONS is available, in which
705 *	case the registration can also be modified to include/exclude the
706 *	flag, rather than requiring unregistration to change it.
707 * @NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_ACTION: Alias for @NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_FRAME for
708 *	backward compatibility
709 * @NL80211_CMD_FRAME: Management frame TX request and RX notification. This
710 *	command is used both as a request to transmit a management frame and
711 *	as an event indicating reception of a frame that was not processed in
712 *	kernel code, but is for us (i.e., which may need to be processed in a
713 *	user space application). %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME is used to specify the
714 *	frame contents (including header). %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ is used
715 *	to indicate on which channel the frame is to be transmitted or was
716 *	received. If this channel is not the current channel (remain-on-channel
717 *	or the operational channel) the device will switch to the given channel
718 *	and transmit the frame, optionally waiting for a response for the time
719 *	specified using %NL80211_ATTR_DURATION. When called, this operation
720 *	returns a cookie (%NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE) that will be included with the
721 *	TX status event pertaining to the TX request.
722 *	%NL80211_ATTR_TX_NO_CCK_RATE is used to decide whether to send the
723 *	management frames at CCK rate or not in 2GHz band.
724 *	%NL80211_ATTR_CSA_C_OFFSETS_TX is an array of offsets to CSA
725 *	counters which will be updated to the current value. This attribute
726 *	is used during CSA period.
727 * @NL80211_CMD_FRAME_WAIT_CANCEL: When an off-channel TX was requested, this
728 *	command may be used with the corresponding cookie to cancel the wait
729 *	time if it is known that it is no longer necessary.  This command is
730 *	also sent as an event whenever the driver has completed the off-channel
731 *	wait time.
732 * @NL80211_CMD_ACTION: Alias for @NL80211_CMD_FRAME for backward compatibility.
733 * @NL80211_CMD_FRAME_TX_STATUS: Report TX status of a management frame
734 *	transmitted with %NL80211_CMD_FRAME. %NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE identifies
735 *	the TX command and %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME includes the contents of the
736 *	frame. %NL80211_ATTR_ACK flag is included if the recipient acknowledged
737 *	the frame.
738 * @NL80211_CMD_ACTION_TX_STATUS: Alias for @NL80211_CMD_FRAME_TX_STATUS for
739 *	backward compatibility.
740 *
741 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_POWER_SAVE: Set powersave, using %NL80211_ATTR_PS_STATE
742 * @NL80211_CMD_GET_POWER_SAVE: Get powersave status in %NL80211_ATTR_PS_STATE
743 *
744 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_CQM: Connection quality monitor configuration. This command
745 *	is used to configure connection quality monitoring notification trigger
746 *	levels.
747 * @NL80211_CMD_NOTIFY_CQM: Connection quality monitor notification. This
748 *	command is used as an event to indicate the that a trigger level was
749 *	reached.
750 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_CHANNEL: Set the channel (using %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ
751 *	and the attributes determining channel width) the given interface
752 *	(identifed by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX) shall operate on.
753 *	In case multiple channels are supported by the device, the mechanism
754 *	with which it switches channels is implementation-defined.
755 *	When a monitor interface is given, it can only switch channel while
756 *	no other interfaces are operating to avoid disturbing the operation
757 *	of any other interfaces, and other interfaces will again take
758 *	precedence when they are used.
759 *
760 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_WDS_PEER: Set the MAC address of the peer on a WDS interface.
761 *
762 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_MULTICAST_TO_UNICAST: Configure if this AP should perform
763 *	multicast to unicast conversion. When enabled, all multicast packets
764 *	with ethertype ARP, IPv4 or IPv6 (possibly within an 802.1Q header)
765 *	will be sent out to each station once with the destination (multicast)
766 *	MAC address replaced by the station's MAC address. Note that this may
767 *	break certain expectations of the receiver, e.g. the ability to drop
768 *	unicast IP packets encapsulated in multicast L2 frames, or the ability
769 *	to not send destination unreachable messages in such cases.
770 *	This can only be toggled per BSS. Configure this on an interface of
771 *	type %NL80211_IFTYPE_AP. It applies to all its VLAN interfaces
772 *	(%NL80211_IFTYPE_AP_VLAN), except for those in 4addr (WDS) mode.
773 *	If %NL80211_ATTR_MULTICAST_TO_UNICAST_ENABLED is not present with this
774 *	command, the feature is disabled.
775 *
776 * @NL80211_CMD_JOIN_MESH: Join a mesh. The mesh ID must be given, and initial
777 *	mesh config parameters may be given.
778 * @NL80211_CMD_LEAVE_MESH: Leave the mesh network -- no special arguments, the
779 *	network is determined by the network interface.
780 *
781 * @NL80211_CMD_UNPROT_DEAUTHENTICATE: Unprotected deauthentication frame
782 *	notification. This event is used to indicate that an unprotected
783 *	deauthentication frame was dropped when MFP is in use.
784 * @NL80211_CMD_UNPROT_DISASSOCIATE: Unprotected disassociation frame
785 *	notification. This event is used to indicate that an unprotected
786 *	disassociation frame was dropped when MFP is in use.
787 *
788 * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_PEER_CANDIDATE: Notification on the reception of a
789 *      beacon or probe response from a compatible mesh peer.  This is only
790 *      sent while no station information (sta_info) exists for the new peer
791 *      candidate and when @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AUTH,
792 *      @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AMPE, or
793 *      @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_MPM is set.  On reception of this
794 *      notification, userspace may decide to create a new station
795 *      (@NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION).  To stop this notification from
796 *      reoccurring, the userspace authentication daemon may want to create the
797 *      new station with the AUTHENTICATED flag unset and maybe change it later
798 *      depending on the authentication result.
799 *
800 * @NL80211_CMD_GET_WOWLAN: get Wake-on-Wireless-LAN (WoWLAN) settings.
801 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_WOWLAN: set Wake-on-Wireless-LAN (WoWLAN) settings.
802 *	Since wireless is more complex than wired ethernet, it supports
803 *	various triggers. These triggers can be configured through this
804 *	command with the %NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS attribute. For
805 *	more background information, see
806 *	https://wireless.wiki.kernel.org/en/users/Documentation/WoWLAN.
807 *	The @NL80211_CMD_SET_WOWLAN command can also be used as a notification
808 *	from the driver reporting the wakeup reason. In this case, the
809 *	@NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS attribute will contain the reason
810 *	for the wakeup, if it was caused by wireless. If it is not present
811 *	in the wakeup notification, the wireless device didn't cause the
812 *	wakeup but reports that it was woken up.
813 *
814 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_REKEY_OFFLOAD: This command is used give the driver
815 *	the necessary information for supporting GTK rekey offload. This
816 *	feature is typically used during WoWLAN. The configuration data
817 *	is contained in %NL80211_ATTR_REKEY_DATA (which is nested and
818 *	contains the data in sub-attributes). After rekeying happened,
819 *	this command may also be sent by the driver as an MLME event to
820 *	inform userspace of the new replay counter.
821 *
822 * @NL80211_CMD_PMKSA_CANDIDATE: This is used as an event to inform userspace
823 *	of PMKSA caching dandidates.
824 *
825 * @NL80211_CMD_TDLS_OPER: Perform a high-level TDLS command (e.g. link setup).
826 *	In addition, this can be used as an event to request userspace to take
827 *	actions on TDLS links (set up a new link or tear down an existing one).
828 *	In such events, %NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_OPERATION indicates the requested
829 *	operation, %NL80211_ATTR_MAC contains the peer MAC address, and
830 *	%NL80211_ATTR_REASON_CODE the reason code to be used (only with
831 *	%NL80211_TDLS_TEARDOWN).
832 * @NL80211_CMD_TDLS_MGMT: Send a TDLS management frame. The
833 *	%NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_ACTION attribute determines the type of frame to be
834 *	sent. Public Action codes (802.11-2012 8.1.5.1) will be sent as
835 *	802.11 management frames, while TDLS action codes (802.11-2012
836 *	8.5.13.1) will be encapsulated and sent as data frames. The currently
837 *	supported Public Action code is %WLAN_PUB_ACTION_TDLS_DISCOVER_RES
838 *	and the currently supported TDLS actions codes are given in
839 *	&enum ieee80211_tdls_actioncode.
840 *
841 * @NL80211_CMD_UNEXPECTED_FRAME: Used by an application controlling an AP
842 *	(or GO) interface (i.e. hostapd) to ask for unexpected frames to
843 *	implement sending deauth to stations that send unexpected class 3
844 *	frames. Also used as the event sent by the kernel when such a frame
845 *	is received.
846 *	For the event, the %NL80211_ATTR_MAC attribute carries the TA and
847 *	other attributes like the interface index are present.
848 *	If used as the command it must have an interface index and you can
849 *	only unsubscribe from the event by closing the socket. Subscription
850 *	is also for %NL80211_CMD_UNEXPECTED_4ADDR_FRAME events.
851 *
852 * @NL80211_CMD_UNEXPECTED_4ADDR_FRAME: Sent as an event indicating that the
853 *	associated station identified by %NL80211_ATTR_MAC sent a 4addr frame
854 *	and wasn't already in a 4-addr VLAN. The event will be sent similarly
855 *	to the %NL80211_CMD_UNEXPECTED_FRAME event, to the same listener.
856 *
857 * @NL80211_CMD_PROBE_CLIENT: Probe an associated station on an AP interface
858 *	by sending a null data frame to it and reporting when the frame is
859 *	acknowleged. This is used to allow timing out inactive clients. Uses
860 *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX and %NL80211_ATTR_MAC. The command returns a
861 *	direct reply with an %NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE that is later used to match
862 *	up the event with the request. The event includes the same data and
863 *	has %NL80211_ATTR_ACK set if the frame was ACKed.
864 *
865 * @NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_BEACONS: Register this socket to receive beacons from
866 *	other BSSes when any interfaces are in AP mode. This helps implement
867 *	OLBC handling in hostapd. Beacons are reported in %NL80211_CMD_FRAME
868 *	messages. Note that per PHY only one application may register.
869 *
870 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_NOACK_MAP: sets a bitmap for the individual TIDs whether
871 *      No Acknowledgement Policy should be applied.
872 *
873 * @NL80211_CMD_CH_SWITCH_NOTIFY: An AP or GO may decide to switch channels
874 *	independently of the userspace SME, send this event indicating
875 *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX is now on %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ and the
876 *	attributes determining channel width.  This indication may also be
877 *	sent when a remotely-initiated switch (e.g., when a STA receives a CSA
878 *	from the remote AP) is completed;
879 *
880 * @NL80211_CMD_CH_SWITCH_STARTED_NOTIFY: Notify that a channel switch
881 *	has been started on an interface, regardless of the initiator
882 *	(ie. whether it was requested from a remote device or
883 *	initiated on our own).  It indicates that
884 *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX will be on %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ
885 *	after %NL80211_ATTR_CH_SWITCH_COUNT TBTT's.  The userspace may
886 *	decide to react to this indication by requesting other
887 *	interfaces to change channel as well.
888 *
889 * @NL80211_CMD_START_P2P_DEVICE: Start the given P2P Device, identified by
890 *	its %NL80211_ATTR_WDEV identifier. It must have been created with
891 *	%NL80211_CMD_NEW_INTERFACE previously. After it has been started, the
892 *	P2P Device can be used for P2P operations, e.g. remain-on-channel and
893 *	public action frame TX.
894 * @NL80211_CMD_STOP_P2P_DEVICE: Stop the given P2P Device, identified by
895 *	its %NL80211_ATTR_WDEV identifier.
896 *
897 * @NL80211_CMD_CONN_FAILED: connection request to an AP failed; used to
898 *	notify userspace that AP has rejected the connection request from a
899 *	station, due to particular reason. %NL80211_ATTR_CONN_FAILED_REASON
900 *	is used for this.
901 *
902 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_MCAST_RATE: Change the rate used to send multicast frames
903 *	for IBSS or MESH vif.
904 *
905 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_MAC_ACL: sets ACL for MAC address based access control.
906 *	This is to be used with the drivers advertising the support of MAC
907 *	address based access control. List of MAC addresses is passed in
908 *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC_ADDRS and ACL policy is passed in
909 *	%NL80211_ATTR_ACL_POLICY. Driver will enable ACL with this list, if it
910 *	is not already done. The new list will replace any existing list. Driver
911 *	will clear its ACL when the list of MAC addresses passed is empty. This
912 *	command is used in AP/P2P GO mode. Driver has to make sure to clear its
913 *	ACL list during %NL80211_CMD_STOP_AP.
914 *
915 * @NL80211_CMD_RADAR_DETECT: Start a Channel availability check (CAC). Once
916 *	a radar is detected or the channel availability scan (CAC) has finished
917 *	or was aborted, or a radar was detected, usermode will be notified with
918 *	this event. This command is also used to notify userspace about radars
919 *	while operating on this channel.
920 *	%NL80211_ATTR_RADAR_EVENT is used to inform about the type of the
921 *	event.
922 *
923 * @NL80211_CMD_GET_PROTOCOL_FEATURES: Get global nl80211 protocol features,
924 *	i.e. features for the nl80211 protocol rather than device features.
925 *	Returns the features in the %NL80211_ATTR_PROTOCOL_FEATURES bitmap.
926 *
927 * @NL80211_CMD_UPDATE_FT_IES: Pass down the most up-to-date Fast Transition
928 *	Information Element to the WLAN driver
929 *
930 * @NL80211_CMD_FT_EVENT: Send a Fast transition event from the WLAN driver
931 *	to the supplicant. This will carry the target AP's MAC address along
932 *	with the relevant Information Elements. This event is used to report
933 *	received FT IEs (MDIE, FTIE, RSN IE, TIE, RICIE).
934 *
935 * @NL80211_CMD_CRIT_PROTOCOL_START: Indicates user-space will start running
936 *	a critical protocol that needs more reliability in the connection to
937 *	complete.
938 *
939 * @NL80211_CMD_CRIT_PROTOCOL_STOP: Indicates the connection reliability can
940 *	return back to normal.
941 *
942 * @NL80211_CMD_GET_COALESCE: Get currently supported coalesce rules.
943 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_COALESCE: Configure coalesce rules or clear existing rules.
944 *
945 * @NL80211_CMD_CHANNEL_SWITCH: Perform a channel switch by announcing the
946 *	new channel information (Channel Switch Announcement - CSA)
947 *	in the beacon for some time (as defined in the
948 *	%NL80211_ATTR_CH_SWITCH_COUNT parameter) and then change to the
949 *	new channel. Userspace provides the new channel information (using
950 *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ and the attributes determining channel
951 *	width). %NL80211_ATTR_CH_SWITCH_BLOCK_TX may be supplied to inform
952 *	other station that transmission must be blocked until the channel
953 *	switch is complete.
954 *
955 * @NL80211_CMD_VENDOR: Vendor-specified command/event. The command is specified
956 *	by the %NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_ID attribute and a sub-command in
957 *	%NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_SUBCMD. Parameter(s) can be transported in
958 *	%NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA.
959 *	For feature advertisement, the %NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA attribute is
960 *	used in the wiphy data as a nested attribute containing descriptions
961 *	(&struct nl80211_vendor_cmd_info) of the supported vendor commands.
962 *	This may also be sent as an event with the same attributes.
963 *
964 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_QOS_MAP: Set Interworking QoS mapping for IP DSCP values.
965 *	The QoS mapping information is included in %NL80211_ATTR_QOS_MAP. If
966 *	that attribute is not included, QoS mapping is disabled. Since this
967 *	QoS mapping is relevant for IP packets, it is only valid during an
968 *	association. This is cleared on disassociation and AP restart.
969 *
970 * @NL80211_CMD_ADD_TX_TS: Ask the kernel to add a traffic stream for the given
971 *	%NL80211_ATTR_TSID and %NL80211_ATTR_MAC with %NL80211_ATTR_USER_PRIO
972 *	and %NL80211_ATTR_ADMITTED_TIME parameters.
973 *	Note that the action frame handshake with the AP shall be handled by
974 *	userspace via the normal management RX/TX framework, this only sets
975 *	up the TX TS in the driver/device.
976 *	If the admitted time attribute is not added then the request just checks
977 *	if a subsequent setup could be successful, the intent is to use this to
978 *	avoid setting up a session with the AP when local restrictions would
979 *	make that impossible. However, the subsequent "real" setup may still
980 *	fail even if the check was successful.
981 * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_TX_TS: Remove an existing TS with the %NL80211_ATTR_TSID
982 *	and %NL80211_ATTR_MAC parameters. It isn't necessary to call this
983 *	before removing a station entry entirely, or before disassociating
984 *	or similar, cleanup will happen in the driver/device in this case.
985 *
986 * @NL80211_CMD_GET_MPP: Get mesh path attributes for mesh proxy path to
987 *	destination %NL80211_ATTR_MAC on the interface identified by
988 *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX.
989 *
990 * @NL80211_CMD_JOIN_OCB: Join the OCB network. The center frequency and
991 *	bandwidth of a channel must be given.
992 * @NL80211_CMD_LEAVE_OCB: Leave the OCB network -- no special arguments, the
993 *	network is determined by the network interface.
994 *
995 * @NL80211_CMD_TDLS_CHANNEL_SWITCH: Start channel-switching with a TDLS peer,
996 *	identified by the %NL80211_ATTR_MAC parameter. A target channel is
997 *	provided via %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ and other attributes determining
998 *	channel width/type. The target operating class is given via
999 *	%NL80211_ATTR_OPER_CLASS.
1000 *	The driver is responsible for continually initiating channel-switching
1001 *	operations and returning to the base channel for communication with the
1002 *	AP.
1003 * @NL80211_CMD_TDLS_CANCEL_CHANNEL_SWITCH: Stop channel-switching with a TDLS
1004 *	peer given by %NL80211_ATTR_MAC. Both peers must be on the base channel
1005 *	when this command completes.
1006 *
1007 * @NL80211_CMD_WIPHY_REG_CHANGE: Similar to %NL80211_CMD_REG_CHANGE, but used
1008 *	as an event to indicate changes for devices with wiphy-specific regdom
1009 *	management.
1010 *
1011 * @NL80211_CMD_ABORT_SCAN: Stop an ongoing scan. Returns -ENOENT if a scan is
1012 *	not running. The driver indicates the status of the scan through
1013 *	cfg80211_scan_done().
1014 *
1015 * @NL80211_CMD_START_NAN: Start NAN operation, identified by its
1016 *	%NL80211_ATTR_WDEV interface. This interface must have been
1017 *	previously created with %NL80211_CMD_NEW_INTERFACE. After it
1018 *	has been started, the NAN interface will create or join a
1019 *	cluster. This command must have a valid
1020 *	%NL80211_ATTR_NAN_MASTER_PREF attribute and optional
1021 *	%NL80211_ATTR_BANDS attributes.  If %NL80211_ATTR_BANDS is
1022 *	omitted or set to 0, it means don't-care and the device will
1023 *	decide what to use.  After this command NAN functions can be
1024 *	added.
1025 * @NL80211_CMD_STOP_NAN: Stop the NAN operation, identified by
1026 *	its %NL80211_ATTR_WDEV interface.
1027 * @NL80211_CMD_ADD_NAN_FUNCTION: Add a NAN function. The function is defined
1028 *	with %NL80211_ATTR_NAN_FUNC nested attribute. When called, this
1029 *	operation returns the strictly positive and unique instance id
1030 *	(%NL80211_ATTR_NAN_FUNC_INST_ID) and a cookie (%NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE)
1031 *	of the function upon success.
1032 *	Since instance ID's can be re-used, this cookie is the right
1033 *	way to identify the function. This will avoid races when a termination
1034 *	event is handled by the user space after it has already added a new
1035 *	function that got the same instance id from the kernel as the one
1036 *	which just terminated.
1037 *	This cookie may be used in NAN events even before the command
1038 *	returns, so userspace shouldn't process NAN events until it processes
1039 *	the response to this command.
1040 *	Look at %NL80211_ATTR_SOCKET_OWNER as well.
1041 * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_NAN_FUNCTION: Delete a NAN function by cookie.
1042 *	This command is also used as a notification sent when a NAN function is
1043 *	terminated. This will contain a %NL80211_ATTR_NAN_FUNC_INST_ID
1044 *	and %NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE attributes.
1045 * @NL80211_CMD_CHANGE_NAN_CONFIG: Change current NAN
1046 *	configuration. NAN must be operational (%NL80211_CMD_START_NAN
1047 *	was executed).  It must contain at least one of the following
1048 *	attributes: %NL80211_ATTR_NAN_MASTER_PREF,
1049 *	%NL80211_ATTR_BANDS.  If %NL80211_ATTR_BANDS is omitted, the
1050 *	current configuration is not changed.  If it is present but
1051 *	set to zero, the configuration is changed to don't-care
1052 *	(i.e. the device can decide what to do).
1053 * @NL80211_CMD_NAN_FUNC_MATCH: Notification sent when a match is reported.
1054 *	This will contain a %NL80211_ATTR_NAN_MATCH nested attribute and
1055 *	%NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE.
1056 *
1057 * @NL80211_CMD_UPDATE_CONNECT_PARAMS: Update one or more connect parameters
1058 *	for subsequent roaming cases if the driver or firmware uses internal
1059 *	BSS selection. This command can be issued only while connected and it
1060 *	does not result in a change for the current association. Currently,
1061 *	only the %NL80211_ATTR_IE data is used and updated with this command.
1062 *
1063 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_PMK: For offloaded 4-Way handshake, set the PMK or PMK-R0
1064 *	for the given authenticator address (specified with %NL80211_ATTR_MAC).
1065 *	When %NL80211_ATTR_PMKR0_NAME is set, %NL80211_ATTR_PMK specifies the
1066 *	PMK-R0, otherwise it specifies the PMK.
1067 * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_PMK: For offloaded 4-Way handshake, delete the previously
1068 *	configured PMK for the authenticator address identified by
1069 *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC.
1070 * @NL80211_CMD_PORT_AUTHORIZED: An event that indicates an 802.1X FT roam was
1071 *	completed successfully. Drivers that support 4 way handshake offload
1072 *	should send this event after indicating 802.1X FT assocation with
1073 *	%NL80211_CMD_ROAM. If the 4 way handshake failed %NL80211_CMD_DISCONNECT
1074 *	should be indicated instead.
1075 * @NL80211_CMD_CONTROL_PORT_FRAME: Control Port (e.g. PAE) frame TX request
1076 *	and RX notification.  This command is used both as a request to transmit
1077 *	a control port frame and as a notification that a control port frame
1078 *	has been received. %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME is used to specify the
1079 *	frame contents.  The frame is the raw EAPoL data, without ethernet or
1080 *	802.11 headers.
1081 *	When used as an event indication %NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_ETHERTYPE,
1082 *	%NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_NO_ENCRYPT and %NL80211_ATTR_MAC are added
1083 *	indicating the protocol type of the received frame; whether the frame
1084 *	was received unencrypted and the MAC address of the peer respectively.
1085 *
1086 * @NL80211_CMD_RELOAD_REGDB: Request that the regdb firmware file is reloaded.
1087 *
1088 * @NL80211_CMD_EXTERNAL_AUTH: This interface is exclusively defined for host
1089 *	drivers that do not define separate commands for authentication and
1090 *	association, but rely on user space for the authentication to happen.
1091 *	This interface acts both as the event request (driver to user space)
1092 *	to trigger the authentication and command response (userspace to
1093 *	driver) to indicate the authentication status.
1094 *
1095 *	User space uses the %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT command to the host driver to
1096 *	trigger a connection. The host driver selects a BSS and further uses
1097 *	this interface to offload only the authentication part to the user
1098 *	space. Authentication frames are passed between the driver and user
1099 *	space through the %NL80211_CMD_FRAME interface. Host driver proceeds
1100 *	further with the association after getting successful authentication
1101 *	status. User space indicates the authentication status through
1102 *	%NL80211_ATTR_STATUS_CODE attribute in %NL80211_CMD_EXTERNAL_AUTH
1103 *	command interface.
1104 *
1105 *	Host driver reports this status on an authentication failure to the
1106 *	user space through the connect result as the user space would have
1107 *	initiated the connection through the connect request.
1108 *
1109 * @NL80211_CMD_STA_OPMODE_CHANGED: An event that notify station's
1110 *	ht opmode or vht opmode changes using any of %NL80211_ATTR_SMPS_MODE,
1111 *	%NL80211_ATTR_CHANNEL_WIDTH,%NL80211_ATTR_NSS attributes with its
1112 *	address(specified in %NL80211_ATTR_MAC).
1113 *
1114 * @NL80211_CMD_GET_FTM_RESPONDER_STATS: Retrieve FTM responder statistics, in
1115 *	the %NL80211_ATTR_FTM_RESPONDER_STATS attribute.
1116 *
1117 * @NL80211_CMD_PEER_MEASUREMENT_START: start a (set of) peer measurement(s)
1118 *	with the given parameters, which are encapsulated in the nested
1119 *	%NL80211_ATTR_PEER_MEASUREMENTS attribute. Optionally, MAC address
1120 *	randomization may be enabled and configured by specifying the
1121 *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC and %NL80211_ATTR_MAC_MASK attributes.
1122 *	If a timeout is requested, use the %NL80211_ATTR_TIMEOUT attribute.
1123 *	A u64 cookie for further %NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE use is returned in
1124 *	the netlink extended ack message.
1125 *
1126 *	To cancel a measurement, close the socket that requested it.
1127 *
1128 *	Measurement results are reported to the socket that requested the
1129 *	measurement using @NL80211_CMD_PEER_MEASUREMENT_RESULT when they
1130 *	become available, so applications must ensure a large enough socket
1131 *	buffer size.
1132 *
1133 *	Depending on driver support it may or may not be possible to start
1134 *	multiple concurrent measurements.
1135 * @NL80211_CMD_PEER_MEASUREMENT_RESULT: This command number is used for the
1136 *	result notification from the driver to the requesting socket.
1137 * @NL80211_CMD_PEER_MEASUREMENT_COMPLETE: Notification only, indicating that
1138 *	the measurement completed, using the measurement cookie
1139 *	(%NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE).
1140 *
1141 * @NL80211_CMD_NOTIFY_RADAR: Notify the kernel that a radar signal was
1142 *	detected and reported by a neighboring device on the channel
1143 *	indicated by %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ and other attributes
1144 *	determining the width and type.
1145 *
1146 * @NL80211_CMD_UPDATE_OWE_INFO: This interface allows the host driver to
1147 *	offload OWE processing to user space. This intends to support
1148 *	OWE AKM by the host drivers that implement SME but rely
1149 *	on the user space for the cryptographic/DH IE processing in AP mode.
1150 *
1151 * @NL80211_CMD_PROBE_MESH_LINK: The requirement for mesh link metric
1152 *	refreshing, is that from one mesh point we be able to send some data
1153 *	frames to other mesh points which are not currently selected as a
1154 *	primary traffic path, but which are only 1 hop away. The absence of
1155 *	the primary path to the chosen node makes it necessary to apply some
1156 *	form of marking on a chosen packet stream so that the packets can be
1157 *	properly steered to the selected node for testing, and not by the
1158 *	regular mesh path lookup. Further, the packets must be of type data
1159 *	so that the rate control (often embedded in firmware) is used for
1160 *	rate selection.
1161 *
1162 *	Here attribute %NL80211_ATTR_MAC is used to specify connected mesh
1163 *	peer MAC address and %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME is used to specify the frame
1164 *	content. The frame is ethernet data.
1165 *
1166 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_TID_CONFIG: Data frame TID specific configuration
1167 *	is passed using %NL80211_ATTR_TID_CONFIG attribute.
1168 *
1169 * @NL80211_CMD_UNPROT_BEACON: Unprotected or incorrectly protected Beacon
1170 *	frame. This event is used to indicate that a received Beacon frame was
1171 *	dropped because it did not include a valid MME MIC while beacon
1172 *	protection was enabled (BIGTK configured in station mode).
1173 *
1174 * @NL80211_CMD_CONTROL_PORT_FRAME_TX_STATUS: Report TX status of a control
1175 *	port frame transmitted with %NL80211_CMD_CONTROL_PORT_FRAME.
1176 *	%NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE identifies the TX command and %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME
1177 *	includes the contents of the frame. %NL80211_ATTR_ACK flag is included
1178 *	if the recipient acknowledged the frame.
1179 *
1180 * @NL80211_CMD_MAX: highest used command number
1181 * @__NL80211_CMD_AFTER_LAST: internal use
1182 */
1183enum nl80211_commands {
1184/* don't change the order or add anything between, this is ABI! */
1185	NL80211_CMD_UNSPEC,
1186
1187	NL80211_CMD_GET_WIPHY,		/* can dump */
1188	NL80211_CMD_SET_WIPHY,
1189	NL80211_CMD_NEW_WIPHY,
1190	NL80211_CMD_DEL_WIPHY,
1191
1192	NL80211_CMD_GET_INTERFACE,	/* can dump */
1193	NL80211_CMD_SET_INTERFACE,
1194	NL80211_CMD_NEW_INTERFACE,
1195	NL80211_CMD_DEL_INTERFACE,
1196
1197	NL80211_CMD_GET_KEY,
1198	NL80211_CMD_SET_KEY,
1199	NL80211_CMD_NEW_KEY,
1200	NL80211_CMD_DEL_KEY,
1201
1202	NL80211_CMD_GET_BEACON,
1203	NL80211_CMD_SET_BEACON,
1204	NL80211_CMD_START_AP,
1205	NL80211_CMD_NEW_BEACON = NL80211_CMD_START_AP,
1206	NL80211_CMD_STOP_AP,
1207	NL80211_CMD_DEL_BEACON = NL80211_CMD_STOP_AP,
1208
1209	NL80211_CMD_GET_STATION,
1210	NL80211_CMD_SET_STATION,
1211	NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION,
1212	NL80211_CMD_DEL_STATION,
1213
1214	NL80211_CMD_GET_MPATH,
1215	NL80211_CMD_SET_MPATH,
1216	NL80211_CMD_NEW_MPATH,
1217	NL80211_CMD_DEL_MPATH,
1218
1219	NL80211_CMD_SET_BSS,
1220
1221	NL80211_CMD_SET_REG,
1222	NL80211_CMD_REQ_SET_REG,
1223
1224	NL80211_CMD_GET_MESH_CONFIG,
1225	NL80211_CMD_SET_MESH_CONFIG,
1226
1227	NL80211_CMD_SET_MGMT_EXTRA_IE /* reserved; not used */,
1228
1229	NL80211_CMD_GET_REG,
1230
1231	NL80211_CMD_GET_SCAN,
1232	NL80211_CMD_TRIGGER_SCAN,
1233	NL80211_CMD_NEW_SCAN_RESULTS,
1234	NL80211_CMD_SCAN_ABORTED,
1235
1236	NL80211_CMD_REG_CHANGE,
1237
1238	NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE,
1239	NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE,
1240	NL80211_CMD_DEAUTHENTICATE,
1241	NL80211_CMD_DISASSOCIATE,
1242
1243	NL80211_CMD_MICHAEL_MIC_FAILURE,
1244
1245	NL80211_CMD_REG_BEACON_HINT,
1246
1247	NL80211_CMD_JOIN_IBSS,
1248	NL80211_CMD_LEAVE_IBSS,
1249
1250	NL80211_CMD_TESTMODE,
1251
1252	NL80211_CMD_CONNECT,
1253	NL80211_CMD_ROAM,
1254	NL80211_CMD_DISCONNECT,
1255
1256	NL80211_CMD_SET_WIPHY_NETNS,
1257
1258	NL80211_CMD_GET_SURVEY,
1259	NL80211_CMD_NEW_SURVEY_RESULTS,
1260
1261	NL80211_CMD_SET_PMKSA,
1262	NL80211_CMD_DEL_PMKSA,
1263	NL80211_CMD_FLUSH_PMKSA,
1264
1265	NL80211_CMD_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL,
1266	NL80211_CMD_CANCEL_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL,
1267
1268	NL80211_CMD_SET_TX_BITRATE_MASK,
1269
1270	NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_FRAME,
1271	NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_ACTION = NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_FRAME,
1272	NL80211_CMD_FRAME,
1273	NL80211_CMD_ACTION = NL80211_CMD_FRAME,
1274	NL80211_CMD_FRAME_TX_STATUS,
1275	NL80211_CMD_ACTION_TX_STATUS = NL80211_CMD_FRAME_TX_STATUS,
1276
1277	NL80211_CMD_SET_POWER_SAVE,
1278	NL80211_CMD_GET_POWER_SAVE,
1279
1280	NL80211_CMD_SET_CQM,
1281	NL80211_CMD_NOTIFY_CQM,
1282
1283	NL80211_CMD_SET_CHANNEL,
1284	NL80211_CMD_SET_WDS_PEER,
1285
1286	NL80211_CMD_FRAME_WAIT_CANCEL,
1287
1288	NL80211_CMD_JOIN_MESH,
1289	NL80211_CMD_LEAVE_MESH,
1290
1291	NL80211_CMD_UNPROT_DEAUTHENTICATE,
1292	NL80211_CMD_UNPROT_DISASSOCIATE,
1293
1294	NL80211_CMD_NEW_PEER_CANDIDATE,
1295
1296	NL80211_CMD_GET_WOWLAN,
1297	NL80211_CMD_SET_WOWLAN,
1298
1299	NL80211_CMD_START_SCHED_SCAN,
1300	NL80211_CMD_STOP_SCHED_SCAN,
1301	NL80211_CMD_SCHED_SCAN_RESULTS,
1302	NL80211_CMD_SCHED_SCAN_STOPPED,
1303
1304	NL80211_CMD_SET_REKEY_OFFLOAD,
1305
1306	NL80211_CMD_PMKSA_CANDIDATE,
1307
1308	NL80211_CMD_TDLS_OPER,
1309	NL80211_CMD_TDLS_MGMT,
1310
1311	NL80211_CMD_UNEXPECTED_FRAME,
1312
1313	NL80211_CMD_PROBE_CLIENT,
1314
1315	NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_BEACONS,
1316
1317	NL80211_CMD_UNEXPECTED_4ADDR_FRAME,
1318
1319	NL80211_CMD_SET_NOACK_MAP,
1320
1321	NL80211_CMD_CH_SWITCH_NOTIFY,
1322
1323	NL80211_CMD_START_P2P_DEVICE,
1324	NL80211_CMD_STOP_P2P_DEVICE,
1325
1326	NL80211_CMD_CONN_FAILED,
1327
1328	NL80211_CMD_SET_MCAST_RATE,
1329
1330	NL80211_CMD_SET_MAC_ACL,
1331
1332	NL80211_CMD_RADAR_DETECT,
1333
1334	NL80211_CMD_GET_PROTOCOL_FEATURES,
1335
1336	NL80211_CMD_UPDATE_FT_IES,
1337	NL80211_CMD_FT_EVENT,
1338
1339	NL80211_CMD_CRIT_PROTOCOL_START,
1340	NL80211_CMD_CRIT_PROTOCOL_STOP,
1341
1342	NL80211_CMD_GET_COALESCE,
1343	NL80211_CMD_SET_COALESCE,
1344
1345	NL80211_CMD_CHANNEL_SWITCH,
1346
1347	NL80211_CMD_VENDOR,
1348
1349	NL80211_CMD_SET_QOS_MAP,
1350
1351	NL80211_CMD_ADD_TX_TS,
1352	NL80211_CMD_DEL_TX_TS,
1353
1354	NL80211_CMD_GET_MPP,
1355
1356	NL80211_CMD_JOIN_OCB,
1357	NL80211_CMD_LEAVE_OCB,
1358
1359	NL80211_CMD_CH_SWITCH_STARTED_NOTIFY,
1360
1361	NL80211_CMD_TDLS_CHANNEL_SWITCH,
1362	NL80211_CMD_TDLS_CANCEL_CHANNEL_SWITCH,
1363
1364	NL80211_CMD_WIPHY_REG_CHANGE,
1365
1366	NL80211_CMD_ABORT_SCAN,
1367
1368	NL80211_CMD_START_NAN,
1369	NL80211_CMD_STOP_NAN,
1370	NL80211_CMD_ADD_NAN_FUNCTION,
1371	NL80211_CMD_DEL_NAN_FUNCTION,
1372	NL80211_CMD_CHANGE_NAN_CONFIG,
1373	NL80211_CMD_NAN_MATCH,
1374
1375	NL80211_CMD_SET_MULTICAST_TO_UNICAST,
1376
1377	NL80211_CMD_UPDATE_CONNECT_PARAMS,
1378
1379	NL80211_CMD_SET_PMK,
1380	NL80211_CMD_DEL_PMK,
1381
1382	NL80211_CMD_PORT_AUTHORIZED,
1383
1384	NL80211_CMD_RELOAD_REGDB,
1385
1386	NL80211_CMD_EXTERNAL_AUTH,
1387
1388	NL80211_CMD_STA_OPMODE_CHANGED,
1389
1390	NL80211_CMD_CONTROL_PORT_FRAME,
1391
1392	NL80211_CMD_GET_FTM_RESPONDER_STATS,
1393
1394	NL80211_CMD_PEER_MEASUREMENT_START,
1395	NL80211_CMD_PEER_MEASUREMENT_RESULT,
1396	NL80211_CMD_PEER_MEASUREMENT_COMPLETE,
1397
1398	NL80211_CMD_NOTIFY_RADAR,
1399
1400	NL80211_CMD_UPDATE_OWE_INFO,
1401
1402	NL80211_CMD_PROBE_MESH_LINK,
1403
1404	NL80211_CMD_SET_TID_CONFIG,
1405
1406	NL80211_CMD_UNPROT_BEACON,
1407
1408	NL80211_CMD_CONTROL_PORT_FRAME_TX_STATUS,
1409
1410	/* add new commands above here */
1411
1412	/* used to define NL80211_CMD_MAX below */
1413	__NL80211_CMD_AFTER_LAST,
1414	NL80211_CMD_MAX = __NL80211_CMD_AFTER_LAST - 1
1415};
1416
1417/*
1418 * Allow user space programs to use #ifdef on new commands by defining them
1419 * here
1420 */
1421#define NL80211_CMD_SET_BSS NL80211_CMD_SET_BSS
1422#define NL80211_CMD_SET_MGMT_EXTRA_IE NL80211_CMD_SET_MGMT_EXTRA_IE
1423#define NL80211_CMD_REG_CHANGE NL80211_CMD_REG_CHANGE
1424#define NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE
1425#define NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE
1426#define NL80211_CMD_DEAUTHENTICATE NL80211_CMD_DEAUTHENTICATE
1427#define NL80211_CMD_DISASSOCIATE NL80211_CMD_DISASSOCIATE
1428#define NL80211_CMD_REG_BEACON_HINT NL80211_CMD_REG_BEACON_HINT
1429
1430#define NL80211_ATTR_FEATURE_FLAGS NL80211_ATTR_FEATURE_FLAGS
1431
1432/* source-level API compatibility */
1433#define NL80211_CMD_GET_MESH_PARAMS NL80211_CMD_GET_MESH_CONFIG
1434#define NL80211_CMD_SET_MESH_PARAMS NL80211_CMD_SET_MESH_CONFIG
1435#define NL80211_MESH_SETUP_VENDOR_PATH_SEL_IE NL80211_MESH_SETUP_IE
1436
1437/**
1438 * enum nl80211_attrs - nl80211 netlink attributes
1439 *
1440 * @NL80211_ATTR_UNSPEC: unspecified attribute to catch errors
1441 *
1442 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY: index of wiphy to operate on, cf.
1443 *	/sys/class/ieee80211/<phyname>/index
1444 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_NAME: wiphy name (used for renaming)
1445 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TXQ_PARAMS: a nested array of TX queue parameters
1446 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ: frequency of the selected channel in MHz,
1447 *	defines the channel together with the (deprecated)
1448 *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_CHANNEL_TYPE attribute or the attributes
1449 *	%NL80211_ATTR_CHANNEL_WIDTH and if needed %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1
1450 *	and %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ2
1451 * @NL80211_ATTR_CHANNEL_WIDTH: u32 attribute containing one of the values
1452 *	of &enum nl80211_chan_width, describing the channel width. See the
1453 *	documentation of the enum for more information.
1454 * @NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1: Center frequency of the first part of the
1455 *	channel, used for anything but 20 MHz bandwidth. In S1G this is the
1456 *	operating channel center frequency.
1457 * @NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ2: Center frequency of the second part of the
1458 *	channel, used only for 80+80 MHz bandwidth
1459 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_CHANNEL_TYPE: included with NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ
1460 *	if HT20 or HT40 are to be used (i.e., HT disabled if not included):
1461 *	NL80211_CHAN_NO_HT = HT not allowed (i.e., same as not including
1462 *		this attribute)
1463 *	NL80211_CHAN_HT20 = HT20 only
1464 *	NL80211_CHAN_HT40MINUS = secondary channel is below the primary channel
1465 *	NL80211_CHAN_HT40PLUS = secondary channel is above the primary channel
1466 *	This attribute is now deprecated.
1467 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RETRY_SHORT: TX retry limit for frames whose length is
1468 *	less than or equal to the RTS threshold; allowed range: 1..255;
1469 *	dot11ShortRetryLimit; u8
1470 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RETRY_LONG: TX retry limit for frames whose length is
1471 *	greater than the RTS threshold; allowed range: 1..255;
1472 *	dot11ShortLongLimit; u8
1473 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FRAG_THRESHOLD: fragmentation threshold, i.e., maximum
1474 *	length in octets for frames; allowed range: 256..8000, disable
1475 *	fragmentation with (u32)-1; dot11FragmentationThreshold; u32
1476 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RTS_THRESHOLD: RTS threshold (TX frames with length
1477 *	larger than or equal to this use RTS/CTS handshake); allowed range:
1478 *	0..65536, disable with (u32)-1; dot11RTSThreshold; u32
1479 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_COVERAGE_CLASS: Coverage Class as defined by IEEE 802.11
1480 *	section 7.3.2.9; dot11CoverageClass; u8
1481 *
1482 * @NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX: network interface index of the device to operate on
1483 * @NL80211_ATTR_IFNAME: network interface name
1484 * @NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE: type of virtual interface, see &enum nl80211_iftype
1485 *
1486 * @NL80211_ATTR_WDEV: wireless device identifier, used for pseudo-devices
1487 *	that don't have a netdev (u64)
1488 *
1489 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAC: MAC address (various uses)
1490 *
1491 * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DATA: (temporal) key data; for TKIP this consists of
1492 *	16 bytes encryption key followed by 8 bytes each for TX and RX MIC
1493 *	keys
1494 * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_IDX: key ID (u8, 0-3)
1495 * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_CIPHER: key cipher suite (u32, as defined by IEEE 802.11
1496 *	section 7.3.2.25.1, e.g. 0x000FAC04)
1497 * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_SEQ: transmit key sequence number (IV/PN) for TKIP and
1498 *	CCMP keys, each six bytes in little endian
1499 * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT: Flag attribute indicating the key is default key
1500 * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT_MGMT: Flag attribute indicating the key is the
1501 *	default management key
1502 * @NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITES_PAIRWISE: For crypto settings for connect or
1503 *	other commands, indicates which pairwise cipher suites are used
1504 * @NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITE_GROUP: For crypto settings for connect or
1505 *	other commands, indicates which group cipher suite is used
1506 *
1507 * @NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_INTERVAL: beacon interval in TU
1508 * @NL80211_ATTR_DTIM_PERIOD: DTIM period for beaconing
1509 * @NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_HEAD: portion of the beacon before the TIM IE
1510 * @NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_TAIL: portion of the beacon after the TIM IE
1511 *
1512 * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_AID: Association ID for the station (u16)
1513 * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_FLAGS: flags, nested element with NLA_FLAG attributes of
1514 *	&enum nl80211_sta_flags (deprecated, use %NL80211_ATTR_STA_FLAGS2)
1515 * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_LISTEN_INTERVAL: listen interval as defined by
1516 *	IEEE 802.11 7.3.1.6 (u16).
1517 * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORTED_RATES: supported rates, array of supported
1518 *	rates as defined by IEEE 802.11 7.3.2.2 but without the length
1519 *	restriction (at most %NL80211_MAX_SUPP_RATES).
1520 * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_VLAN: interface index of VLAN interface to move station
1521 *	to, or the AP interface the station was originally added to.
1522 * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_INFO: information about a station, part of station info
1523 *	given for %NL80211_CMD_GET_STATION, nested attribute containing
1524 *	info as possible, see &enum nl80211_sta_info.
1525 *
1526 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_BANDS: Information about an operating bands,
1527 *	consisting of a nested array.
1528 *
1529 * @NL80211_ATTR_MESH_ID: mesh id (1-32 bytes).
1530 * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_PLINK_ACTION: action to perform on the mesh peer link
1531 *	(see &enum nl80211_plink_action).
1532 * @NL80211_ATTR_MPATH_NEXT_HOP: MAC address of the next hop for a mesh path.
1533 * @NL80211_ATTR_MPATH_INFO: information about a mesh_path, part of mesh path
1534 * 	info given for %NL80211_CMD_GET_MPATH, nested attribute described at
1535 *	&enum nl80211_mpath_info.
1536 *
1537 * @NL80211_ATTR_MNTR_FLAGS: flags, nested element with NLA_FLAG attributes of
1538 *      &enum nl80211_mntr_flags.
1539 *
1540 * @NL80211_ATTR_REG_ALPHA2: an ISO-3166-alpha2 country code for which the
1541 * 	current regulatory domain should be set to or is already set to.
1542 * 	For example, 'CR', for Costa Rica. This attribute is used by the kernel
1543 * 	to query the CRDA to retrieve one regulatory domain. This attribute can
1544 * 	also be used by userspace to query the kernel for the currently set
1545 * 	regulatory domain. We chose an alpha2 as that is also used by the
1546 * 	IEEE-802.11 country information element to identify a country.
1547 * 	Users can also simply ask the wireless core to set regulatory domain
1548 * 	to a specific alpha2.
1549 * @NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULES: a nested array of regulatory domain regulatory
1550 *	rules.
1551 *
1552 * @NL80211_ATTR_BSS_CTS_PROT: whether CTS protection is enabled (u8, 0 or 1)
1553 * @NL80211_ATTR_BSS_SHORT_PREAMBLE: whether short preamble is enabled
1554 *	(u8, 0 or 1)
1555 * @NL80211_ATTR_BSS_SHORT_SLOT_TIME: whether short slot time enabled
1556 *	(u8, 0 or 1)
1557 * @NL80211_ATTR_BSS_BASIC_RATES: basic rates, array of basic
1558 *	rates in format defined by IEEE 802.11 7.3.2.2 but without the length
1559 *	restriction (at most %NL80211_MAX_SUPP_RATES).
1560 *
1561 * @NL80211_ATTR_HT_CAPABILITY: HT Capability information element (from
1562 *	association request when used with NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION)
1563 *
1564 * @NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORTED_IFTYPES: nested attribute containing all
1565 *	supported interface types, each a flag attribute with the number
1566 *	of the interface mode.
1567 *
1568 * @NL80211_ATTR_MGMT_SUBTYPE: Management frame subtype for
1569 *	%NL80211_CMD_SET_MGMT_EXTRA_IE.
1570 *
1571 * @NL80211_ATTR_IE: Information element(s) data (used, e.g., with
1572 *	%NL80211_CMD_SET_MGMT_EXTRA_IE).
1573 *
1574 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_SCAN_SSIDS: number of SSIDs you can scan with
1575 *	a single scan request, a wiphy attribute.
1576 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_SCHED_SCAN_SSIDS: number of SSIDs you can
1577 *	scan with a single scheduled scan request, a wiphy attribute.
1578 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCAN_IE_LEN: maximum length of information elements
1579 *	that can be added to a scan request
1580 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCHED_SCAN_IE_LEN: maximum length of information
1581 *	elements that can be added to a scheduled scan request
1582 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_MATCH_SETS: maximum number of sets that can be
1583 *	used with @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH, a wiphy attribute.
1584 *
1585 * @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQUENCIES: nested attribute with frequencies (in MHz)
1586 * @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_SSIDS: nested attribute with SSIDs, leave out for passive
1587 *	scanning and include a zero-length SSID (wildcard) for wildcard scan
1588 * @NL80211_ATTR_BSS: scan result BSS
1589 *
1590 * @NL80211_ATTR_REG_INITIATOR: indicates who requested the regulatory domain
1591 * 	currently in effect. This could be any of the %NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_*
1592 * @NL80211_ATTR_REG_TYPE: indicates the type of the regulatory domain currently
1593 * 	set. This can be one of the nl80211_reg_type (%NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_*)
1594 *
1595 * @NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORTED_COMMANDS: wiphy attribute that specifies
1596 *	an array of command numbers (i.e. a mapping index to command number)
1597 *	that the driver for the given wiphy supports.
1598 *
1599 * @NL80211_ATTR_FRAME: frame data (binary attribute), including frame header
1600 *	and body, but not FCS; used, e.g., with NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE and
1601 *	NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE events
1602 * @NL80211_ATTR_SSID: SSID (binary attribute, 0..32 octets)
1603 * @NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_TYPE: AuthenticationType, see &enum nl80211_auth_type,
1604 *	represented as a u32
1605 * @NL80211_ATTR_REASON_CODE: ReasonCode for %NL80211_CMD_DEAUTHENTICATE and
1606 *	%NL80211_CMD_DISASSOCIATE, u16
1607 *
1608 * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_TYPE: Key Type, see &enum nl80211_key_type, represented as
1609 *	a u32
1610 *
1611 * @NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_BEFORE: A channel which has suffered a regulatory change
1612 * 	due to considerations from a beacon hint. This attribute reflects
1613 * 	the state of the channel _before_ the beacon hint processing. This
1614 * 	attributes consists of a nested attribute containing
1615 * 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_*
1616 * @NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_AFTER: A channel which has suffered a regulatory change
1617 * 	due to considerations from a beacon hint. This attribute reflects
1618 * 	the state of the channel _after_ the beacon hint processing. This
1619 * 	attributes consists of a nested attribute containing
1620 * 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_*
1621 *
1622 * @NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITES: a set of u32 values indicating the supported
1623 *	cipher suites
1624 *
1625 * @NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_FIXED: a flag indicating the IBSS should not try to look
1626 *	for other networks on different channels
1627 *
1628 * @NL80211_ATTR_TIMED_OUT: a flag indicating than an operation timed out; this
1629 *	is used, e.g., with %NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE event
1630 *
1631 * @NL80211_ATTR_USE_MFP: Whether management frame protection (IEEE 802.11w) is
1632 *	used for the association (&enum nl80211_mfp, represented as a u32);
1633 *	this attribute can be used with %NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE and
1634 *	%NL80211_CMD_CONNECT requests. %NL80211_MFP_OPTIONAL is not allowed for
1635 *	%NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE since user space SME is expected and hence, it
1636 *	must have decided whether to use management frame protection or not.
1637 *	Setting %NL80211_MFP_OPTIONAL with a %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT request will
1638 *	let the driver (or the firmware) decide whether to use MFP or not.
1639 *
1640 * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_FLAGS2: Attribute containing a
1641 *	&struct nl80211_sta_flag_update.
1642 *
1643 * @NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT: A flag indicating whether user space controls
1644 *	IEEE 802.1X port, i.e., sets/clears %NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHORIZED, in
1645 *	station mode. If the flag is included in %NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE
1646 *	request, the driver will assume that the port is unauthorized until
1647 *	authorized by user space. Otherwise, port is marked authorized by
1648 *	default in station mode.
1649 * @NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_ETHERTYPE: A 16-bit value indicating the
1650 *	ethertype that will be used for key negotiation. It can be
1651 *	specified with the associate and connect commands. If it is not
1652 *	specified, the value defaults to 0x888E (PAE, 802.1X). This
1653 *	attribute is also used as a flag in the wiphy information to
1654 *	indicate that protocols other than PAE are supported.
1655 * @NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_NO_ENCRYPT: When included along with
1656 *	%NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_ETHERTYPE, indicates that the custom
1657 *	ethertype frames used for key negotiation must not be encrypted.
1658 * @NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_OVER_NL80211: A flag indicating whether control
1659 *	port frames (e.g. of type given in %NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_ETHERTYPE)
1660 *	will be sent directly to the network interface or sent via the NL80211
1661 *	socket.  If this attribute is missing, then legacy behavior of sending
1662 *	control port frames directly to the network interface is used.  If the
1663 *	flag is included, then control port frames are sent over NL80211 instead
1664 *	using %CMD_CONTROL_PORT_FRAME.  If control port routing over NL80211 is
1665 *	to be used then userspace must also use the %NL80211_ATTR_SOCKET_OWNER
1666 *	flag. When used with %NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_NO_PREAUTH, pre-auth
1667 *	frames are not forwared over the control port.
1668 *
1669 * @NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA: Testmode data blob, passed through to the driver.
1670 *	We recommend using nested, driver-specific attributes within this.
1671 *
1672 * @NL80211_ATTR_DISCONNECTED_BY_AP: A flag indicating that the DISCONNECT
1673 *	event was due to the AP disconnecting the station, and not due to
1674 *	a local disconnect request.
1675 * @NL80211_ATTR_STATUS_CODE: StatusCode for the %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT
1676 *	event (u16)
1677 * @NL80211_ATTR_PRIVACY: Flag attribute, used with connect(), indicating
1678 *	that protected APs should be used. This is also used with NEW_BEACON to
1679 *	indicate that the BSS is to use protection.
1680 *
1681 * @NL80211_ATTR_CIPHERS_PAIRWISE: Used with CONNECT, ASSOCIATE, and NEW_BEACON
1682 *	to indicate which unicast key ciphers will be used with the connection
1683 *	(an array of u32).
1684 * @NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_GROUP: Used with CONNECT, ASSOCIATE, and NEW_BEACON to
1685 *	indicate which group key cipher will be used with the connection (a
1686 *	u32).
1687 * @NL80211_ATTR_WPA_VERSIONS: Used with CONNECT, ASSOCIATE, and NEW_BEACON to
1688 *	indicate which WPA version(s) the AP we want to associate with is using
1689 *	(a u32 with flags from &enum nl80211_wpa_versions).
1690 * @NL80211_ATTR_AKM_SUITES: Used with CONNECT, ASSOCIATE, and NEW_BEACON to
1691 *	indicate which key management algorithm(s) to use (an array of u32).
1692 *	This attribute is also sent in response to @NL80211_CMD_GET_WIPHY,
1693 *	indicating the supported AKM suites, intended for specific drivers which
1694 *	implement SME and have constraints on which AKMs are supported and also
1695 *	the cases where an AKM support is offloaded to the driver/firmware.
1696 *	If there is no such notification from the driver, user space should
1697 *	assume the driver supports all the AKM suites.
1698 *
1699 * @NL80211_ATTR_REQ_IE: (Re)association request information elements as
1700 *	sent out by the card, for ROAM and successful CONNECT events.
1701 * @NL80211_ATTR_RESP_IE: (Re)association response information elements as
1702 *	sent by peer, for ROAM and successful CONNECT events.
1703 *
1704 * @NL80211_ATTR_PREV_BSSID: previous BSSID, to be used in ASSOCIATE and CONNECT
1705 *	commands to specify a request to reassociate within an ESS, i.e., to use
1706 *	Reassociate Request frame (with the value of this attribute in the
1707 *	Current AP address field) instead of Association Request frame which is
1708 *	used for the initial association to an ESS.
1709 *
1710 * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY: key information in a nested attribute with
1711 *	%NL80211_KEY_* sub-attributes
1712 * @NL80211_ATTR_KEYS: array of keys for static WEP keys for connect()
1713 *	and join_ibss(), key information is in a nested attribute each
1714 *	with %NL80211_KEY_* sub-attributes
1715 *
1716 * @NL80211_ATTR_PID: Process ID of a network namespace.
1717 *
1718 * @NL80211_ATTR_GENERATION: Used to indicate consistent snapshots for
1719 *	dumps. This number increases whenever the object list being
1720 *	dumped changes, and as such userspace can verify that it has
1721 *	obtained a complete and consistent snapshot by verifying that
1722 *	all dump messages contain the same generation number. If it
1723 *	changed then the list changed and the dump should be repeated
1724 *	completely from scratch.
1725 *
1726 * @NL80211_ATTR_4ADDR: Use 4-address frames on a virtual interface
1727 *
1728 * @NL80211_ATTR_SURVEY_INFO: survey information about a channel, part of
1729 *      the survey response for %NL80211_CMD_GET_SURVEY, nested attribute
1730 *      containing info as possible, see &enum survey_info.
1731 *
1732 * @NL80211_ATTR_PMKID: PMK material for PMKSA caching.
1733 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_PMKIDS: maximum number of PMKIDs a firmware can
1734 *	cache, a wiphy attribute.
1735 *
1736 * @NL80211_ATTR_DURATION: Duration of an operation in milliseconds, u32.
1737 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL_DURATION: Device attribute that
1738 *	specifies the maximum duration that can be requested with the
1739 *	remain-on-channel operation, in milliseconds, u32.
1740 *
1741 * @NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE: Generic 64-bit cookie to identify objects.
1742 *
1743 * @NL80211_ATTR_TX_RATES: Nested set of attributes
1744 *	(enum nl80211_tx_rate_attributes) describing TX rates per band. The
1745 *	enum nl80211_band value is used as the index (nla_type() of the nested
1746 *	data. If a band is not included, it will be configured to allow all
1747 *	rates based on negotiated supported rates information. This attribute
1748 *	is used with %NL80211_CMD_SET_TX_BITRATE_MASK and with starting AP,
1749 *	and joining mesh networks (not IBSS yet). In the later case, it must
1750 *	specify just a single bitrate, which is to be used for the beacon.
1751 *	The driver must also specify support for this with the extended
1752 *	features NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_LEGACY,
1753 *	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_HT and
1754 *	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_VHT.
1755 *
1756 * @NL80211_ATTR_FRAME_MATCH: A binary attribute which typically must contain
1757 *	at least one byte, currently used with @NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_FRAME.
1758 * @NL80211_ATTR_FRAME_TYPE: A u16 indicating the frame type/subtype for the
1759 *	@NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_FRAME command.
1760 * @NL80211_ATTR_TX_FRAME_TYPES: wiphy capability attribute, which is a
1761 *	nested attribute of %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME_TYPE attributes, containing
1762 *	information about which frame types can be transmitted with
1763 *	%NL80211_CMD_FRAME.
1764 * @NL80211_ATTR_RX_FRAME_TYPES: wiphy capability attribute, which is a
1765 *	nested attribute of %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME_TYPE attributes, containing
1766 *	information about which frame types can be registered for RX.
1767 *
1768 * @NL80211_ATTR_ACK: Flag attribute indicating that the frame was
1769 *	acknowledged by the recipient.
1770 *
1771 * @NL80211_ATTR_PS_STATE: powersave state, using &enum nl80211_ps_state values.
1772 *
1773 * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM: connection quality monitor configuration in a
1774 *	nested attribute with %NL80211_ATTR_CQM_* sub-attributes.
1775 *
1776 * @NL80211_ATTR_LOCAL_STATE_CHANGE: Flag attribute to indicate that a command
1777 *	is requesting a local authentication/association state change without
1778 *	invoking actual management frame exchange. This can be used with
1779 *	NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE, NL80211_CMD_DEAUTHENTICATE,
1780 *	NL80211_CMD_DISASSOCIATE.
1781 *
1782 * @NL80211_ATTR_AP_ISOLATE: (AP mode) Do not forward traffic between stations
1783 *	connected to this BSS.
1784 *
1785 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TX_POWER_SETTING: Transmit power setting type. See
1786 *      &enum nl80211_tx_power_setting for possible values.
1787 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TX_POWER_LEVEL: Transmit power level in signed mBm units.
1788 *      This is used in association with @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TX_POWER_SETTING
1789 *      for non-automatic settings.
1790 *
1791 * @NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_IBSS_RSN: The device supports IBSS RSN, which mostly
1792 *	means support for per-station GTKs.
1793 *
1794 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_TX: Bitmap of allowed antennas for transmitting.
1795 *	This can be used to mask out antennas which are not attached or should
1796 *	not be used for transmitting. If an antenna is not selected in this
1797 *	bitmap the hardware is not allowed to transmit on this antenna.
1798 *
1799 *	Each bit represents one antenna, starting with antenna 1 at the first
1800 *	bit. Depending on which antennas are selected in the bitmap, 802.11n
1801 *	drivers can derive which chainmasks to use (if all antennas belonging to
1802 *	a particular chain are disabled this chain should be disabled) and if
1803 *	a chain has diversity antennas wether diversity should be used or not.
1804 *	HT capabilities (STBC, TX Beamforming, Antenna selection) can be
1805 *	derived from the available chains after applying the antenna mask.
1806 *	Non-802.11n drivers can derive wether to use diversity or not.
1807 *	Drivers may reject configurations or RX/TX mask combinations they cannot
1808 *	support by returning -EINVAL.
1809 *
1810 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_RX: Bitmap of allowed antennas for receiving.
1811 *	This can be used to mask out antennas which are not attached or should
1812 *	not be used for receiving. If an antenna is not selected in this bitmap
1813 *	the hardware should not be configured to receive on this antenna.
1814 *	For a more detailed description see @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_TX.
1815 *
1816 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_AVAIL_TX: Bitmap of antennas which are available
1817 *	for configuration as TX antennas via the above parameters.
1818 *
1819 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_AVAIL_RX: Bitmap of antennas which are available
1820 *	for configuration as RX antennas via the above parameters.
1821 *
1822 * @NL80211_ATTR_MCAST_RATE: Multicast tx rate (in 100 kbps) for IBSS
1823 *
1824 * @NL80211_ATTR_OFFCHANNEL_TX_OK: For management frame TX, the frame may be
1825 *	transmitted on another channel when the channel given doesn't match
1826 *	the current channel. If the current channel doesn't match and this
1827 *	flag isn't set, the frame will be rejected. This is also used as an
1828 *	nl80211 capability flag.
1829 *
1830 * @NL80211_ATTR_BSS_HT_OPMODE: HT operation mode (u16)
1831 *
1832 * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPES: A nested attribute containing flags
1833 *	attributes, specifying what a key should be set as default as.
1834 *	See &enum nl80211_key_default_types.
1835 *
1836 * @NL80211_ATTR_MESH_SETUP: Optional mesh setup parameters.  These cannot be
1837 *	changed once the mesh is active.
1838 * @NL80211_ATTR_MESH_CONFIG: Mesh configuration parameters, a nested attribute
1839 *	containing attributes from &enum nl80211_meshconf_params.
1840 * @NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_MESH_AUTH: Currently, this means the underlying driver
1841 *	allows auth frames in a mesh to be passed to userspace for processing via
1842 *	the @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AUTH flag.
1843 * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_PLINK_STATE: The state of a mesh peer link as defined in
1844 *	&enum nl80211_plink_state. Used when userspace is driving the peer link
1845 *	management state machine.  @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AMPE or
1846 *	@NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_MPM must be enabled.
1847 *
1848 * @NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS_SUPPORTED: indicates, as part of the wiphy
1849 *	capabilities, the supported WoWLAN triggers
1850 * @NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS: used by %NL80211_CMD_SET_WOWLAN to
1851 *	indicate which WoW triggers should be enabled. This is also
1852 *	used by %NL80211_CMD_GET_WOWLAN to get the currently enabled WoWLAN
1853 *	triggers.
1854 *
1855 * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_INTERVAL: Interval between scheduled scan
1856 *	cycles, in msecs.
1857 *
1858 * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH: Nested attribute with one or more
1859 *	sets of attributes to match during scheduled scans.  Only BSSs
1860 *	that match any of the sets will be reported.  These are
1861 *	pass-thru filter rules.
1862 *	For a match to succeed, the BSS must match all attributes of a
1863 *	set.  Since not every hardware supports matching all types of
1864 *	attributes, there is no guarantee that the reported BSSs are
1865 *	fully complying with the match sets and userspace needs to be
1866 *	able to ignore them by itself.
1867 *	Thus, the implementation is somewhat hardware-dependent, but
1868 *	this is only an optimization and the userspace application
1869 *	needs to handle all the non-filtered results anyway.
1870 *	If the match attributes don't make sense when combined with
1871 *	the values passed in @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_SSIDS (eg. if an SSID
1872 *	is included in the probe request, but the match attributes
1873 *	will never let it go through), -EINVAL may be returned.
1874 *	If omitted, no filtering is done.
1875 *
1876 * @NL80211_ATTR_INTERFACE_COMBINATIONS: Nested attribute listing the supported
1877 *	interface combinations. In each nested item, it contains attributes
1878 *	defined in &enum nl80211_if_combination_attrs.
1879 * @NL80211_ATTR_SOFTWARE_IFTYPES: Nested attribute (just like
1880 *	%NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORTED_IFTYPES) containing the interface types that
1881 *	are managed in software: interfaces of these types aren't subject to
1882 *	any restrictions in their number or combinations.
1883 *
1884 * @NL80211_ATTR_REKEY_DATA: nested attribute containing the information
1885 *	necessary for GTK rekeying in the device, see &enum nl80211_rekey_data.
1886 *
1887 * @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_SUPP_RATES: rates per to be advertised as supported in scan,
1888 *	nested array attribute containing an entry for each band, with the entry
1889 *	being a list of supported rates as defined by IEEE 802.11 7.3.2.2 but
1890 *	without the length restriction (at most %NL80211_MAX_SUPP_RATES).
1891 *
1892 * @NL80211_ATTR_HIDDEN_SSID: indicates whether SSID is to be hidden from Beacon
1893 *	and Probe Response (when response to wildcard Probe Request); see
1894 *	&enum nl80211_hidden_ssid, represented as a u32
1895 *
1896 * @NL80211_ATTR_IE_PROBE_RESP: Information element(s) for Probe Response frame.
1897 *	This is used with %NL80211_CMD_NEW_BEACON and %NL80211_CMD_SET_BEACON to
1898 *	provide extra IEs (e.g., WPS/P2P IE) into Probe Response frames when the
1899 *	driver (or firmware) replies to Probe Request frames.
1900 * @NL80211_ATTR_IE_ASSOC_RESP: Information element(s) for (Re)Association
1901 *	Response frames. This is used with %NL80211_CMD_NEW_BEACON and
1902 *	%NL80211_CMD_SET_BEACON to provide extra IEs (e.g., WPS/P2P IE) into
1903 *	(Re)Association Response frames when the driver (or firmware) replies to
1904 *	(Re)Association Request frames.
1905 *
1906 * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_WME: Nested attribute containing the wme configuration
1907 *	of the station, see &enum nl80211_sta_wme_attr.
1908 * @NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_AP_UAPSD: the device supports uapsd when working
1909 *	as AP.
1910 *
1911 * @NL80211_ATTR_ROAM_SUPPORT: Indicates whether the firmware is capable of
1912 *	roaming to another AP in the same ESS if the signal lever is low.
1913 *
1914 * @NL80211_ATTR_PMKSA_CANDIDATE: Nested attribute containing the PMKSA caching
1915 *	candidate information, see &enum nl80211_pmksa_candidate_attr.
1916 *
1917 * @NL80211_ATTR_TX_NO_CCK_RATE: Indicates whether to use CCK rate or not
1918 *	for management frames transmission. In order to avoid p2p probe/action
1919 *	frames are being transmitted at CCK rate in 2GHz band, the user space
1920 *	applications use this attribute.
1921 *	This attribute is used with %NL80211_CMD_TRIGGER_SCAN and
1922 *	%NL80211_CMD_FRAME commands.
1923 *
1924 * @NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_ACTION: Low level TDLS action code (e.g. link setup
1925 *	request, link setup confirm, link teardown, etc.). Values are
1926 *	described in the TDLS (802.11z) specification.
1927 * @NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_DIALOG_TOKEN: Non-zero token for uniquely identifying a
1928 *	TDLS conversation between two devices.
1929 * @NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_OPERATION: High level TDLS operation; see
1930 *	&enum nl80211_tdls_operation, represented as a u8.
1931 * @NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_SUPPORT: A flag indicating the device can operate
1932 *	as a TDLS peer sta.
1933 * @NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_EXTERNAL_SETUP: The TDLS discovery/setup and teardown
1934 *	procedures should be performed by sending TDLS packets via
1935 *	%NL80211_CMD_TDLS_MGMT. Otherwise %NL80211_CMD_TDLS_OPER should be
1936 *	used for asking the driver to perform a TDLS operation.
1937 *
1938 * @NL80211_ATTR_DEVICE_AP_SME: This u32 attribute may be listed for devices
1939 *	that have AP support to indicate that they have the AP SME integrated
1940 *	with support for the features listed in this attribute, see
1941 *	&enum nl80211_ap_sme_features.
1942 *
1943 * @NL80211_ATTR_DONT_WAIT_FOR_ACK: Used with %NL80211_CMD_FRAME, this tells
1944 *	the driver to not wait for an acknowledgement. Note that due to this,
1945 *	it will also not give a status callback nor return a cookie. This is
1946 *	mostly useful for probe responses to save airtime.
1947 *
1948 * @NL80211_ATTR_FEATURE_FLAGS: This u32 attribute contains flags from
1949 *	&enum nl80211_feature_flags and is advertised in wiphy information.
1950 * @NL80211_ATTR_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD: Indicates that the HW responds to probe
1951 *	requests while operating in AP-mode.
1952 *	This attribute holds a bitmap of the supported protocols for
1953 *	offloading (see &enum nl80211_probe_resp_offload_support_attr).
1954 *
1955 * @NL80211_ATTR_PROBE_RESP: Probe Response template data. Contains the entire
1956 *	probe-response frame. The DA field in the 802.11 header is zero-ed out,
1957 *	to be filled by the FW.
1958 * @NL80211_ATTR_DISABLE_HT:  Force HT capable interfaces to disable
1959 *      this feature.  Currently, only supported in mac80211 drivers.
1960 * @NL80211_ATTR_HT_CAPABILITY_MASK: Specify which bits of the
1961 *      ATTR_HT_CAPABILITY to which attention should be paid.
1962 *      Currently, only mac80211 NICs support this feature.
1963 *      The values that may be configured are:
1964 *       MCS rates, MAX-AMSDU, HT-20-40 and HT_CAP_SGI_40
1965 *       AMPDU density and AMPDU factor.
1966 *      All values are treated as suggestions and may be ignored
1967 *      by the driver as required.  The actual values may be seen in
1968 *      the station debugfs ht_caps file.
1969 *
1970 * @NL80211_ATTR_DFS_REGION: region for regulatory rules which this country
1971 *    abides to when initiating radiation on DFS channels. A country maps
1972 *    to one DFS region.
1973 *
1974 * @NL80211_ATTR_NOACK_MAP: This u16 bitmap contains the No Ack Policy of
1975 *      up to 16 TIDs.
1976 *
1977 * @NL80211_ATTR_INACTIVITY_TIMEOUT: timeout value in seconds, this can be
1978 *	used by the drivers which has MLME in firmware and does not have support
1979 *	to report per station tx/rx activity to free up the station entry from
1980 *	the list. This needs to be used when the driver advertises the
1981 *	capability to timeout the stations.
1982 *
1983 * @NL80211_ATTR_RX_SIGNAL_DBM: signal strength in dBm (as a 32-bit int);
1984 *	this attribute is (depending on the driver capabilities) added to
1985 *	received frames indicated with %NL80211_CMD_FRAME.
1986 *
1987 * @NL80211_ATTR_BG_SCAN_PERIOD: Background scan period in seconds
1988 *      or 0 to disable background scan.
1989 *
1990 * @NL80211_ATTR_USER_REG_HINT_TYPE: type of regulatory hint passed from
1991 *	userspace. If unset it is assumed the hint comes directly from
1992 *	a user. If set code could specify exactly what type of source
1993 *	was used to provide the hint. For the different types of
1994 *	allowed user regulatory hints see nl80211_user_reg_hint_type.
1995 *
1996 * @NL80211_ATTR_CONN_FAILED_REASON: The reason for which AP has rejected
1997 *	the connection request from a station. nl80211_connect_failed_reason
1998 *	enum has different reasons of connection failure.
1999 *
2000 * @NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_DATA: Fields and elements in Authentication frames.
2001 *	This contains the authentication frame body (non-IE and IE data),
2002 *	excluding the Authentication algorithm number, i.e., starting at the
2003 *	Authentication transaction sequence number field. It is used with
2004 *	authentication algorithms that need special fields to be added into
2005 *	the frames (SAE and FILS). Currently, only the SAE cases use the
2006 *	initial two fields (Authentication transaction sequence number and
2007 *	Status code). However, those fields are included in the attribute data
2008 *	for all authentication algorithms to keep the attribute definition
2009 *	consistent.
2010 *
2011 * @NL80211_ATTR_VHT_CAPABILITY: VHT Capability information element (from
2012 *	association request when used with NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION)
2013 *
2014 * @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FLAGS: scan request control flags (u32)
2015 *
2016 * @NL80211_ATTR_P2P_CTWINDOW: P2P GO Client Traffic Window (u8), used with
2017 *	the START_AP and SET_BSS commands
2018 * @NL80211_ATTR_P2P_OPPPS: P2P GO opportunistic PS (u8), used with the
2019 *	START_AP and SET_BSS commands. This can have the values 0 or 1;
2020 *	if not given in START_AP 0 is assumed, if not given in SET_BSS
2021 *	no change is made.
2022 *
2023 * @NL80211_ATTR_LOCAL_MESH_POWER_MODE: local mesh STA link-specific power mode
2024 *	defined in &enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode.
2025 *
2026 * @NL80211_ATTR_ACL_POLICY: ACL policy, see &enum nl80211_acl_policy,
2027 *	carried in a u32 attribute
2028 *
2029 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAC_ADDRS: Array of nested MAC addresses, used for
2030 *	MAC ACL.
2031 *
2032 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAC_ACL_MAX: u32 attribute to advertise the maximum
2033 *	number of MAC addresses that a device can support for MAC
2034 *	ACL.
2035 *
2036 * @NL80211_ATTR_RADAR_EVENT: Type of radar event for notification to userspace,
2037 *	contains a value of enum nl80211_radar_event (u32).
2038 *
2039 * @NL80211_ATTR_EXT_CAPA: 802.11 extended capabilities that the kernel driver
2040 *	has and handles. The format is the same as the IE contents. See
2041 *	802.11-2012 8.4.2.29 for more information.
2042 * @NL80211_ATTR_EXT_CAPA_MASK: Extended capabilities that the kernel driver
2043 *	has set in the %NL80211_ATTR_EXT_CAPA value, for multibit fields.
2044 *
2045 * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_CAPABILITY: Station capabilities (u16) are advertised to
2046 *	the driver, e.g., to enable TDLS power save (PU-APSD).
2047 *
2048 * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_EXT_CAPABILITY: Station extended capabilities are
2049 *	advertised to the driver, e.g., to enable TDLS off channel operations
2050 *	and PU-APSD.
2051 *
2052 * @NL80211_ATTR_PROTOCOL_FEATURES: global nl80211 feature flags, see
2053 *	&enum nl80211_protocol_features, the attribute is a u32.
2054 *
2055 * @NL80211_ATTR_SPLIT_WIPHY_DUMP: flag attribute, userspace supports
2056 *	receiving the data for a single wiphy split across multiple
2057 *	messages, given with wiphy dump message
2058 *
2059 * @NL80211_ATTR_MDID: Mobility Domain Identifier
2060 *
2061 * @NL80211_ATTR_IE_RIC: Resource Information Container Information
2062 *	Element
2063 *
2064 * @NL80211_ATTR_CRIT_PROT_ID: critical protocol identifier requiring increased
2065 *	reliability, see &enum nl80211_crit_proto_id (u16).
2066 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_CRIT_PROT_DURATION: duration in milliseconds in which
2067 *      the connection should have increased reliability (u16).
2068 *
2069 * @NL80211_ATTR_PEER_AID: Association ID for the peer TDLS station (u16).
2070 *	This is similar to @NL80211_ATTR_STA_AID but with a difference of being
2071 *	allowed to be used with the first @NL80211_CMD_SET_STATION command to
2072 *	update a TDLS peer STA entry.
2073 *
2074 * @NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE: Coalesce rule information.
2075 *
2076 * @NL80211_ATTR_CH_SWITCH_COUNT: u32 attribute specifying the number of TBTT's
2077 *	until the channel switch event.
2078 * @NL80211_ATTR_CH_SWITCH_BLOCK_TX: flag attribute specifying that transmission
2079 *	must be blocked on the current channel (before the channel switch
2080 *	operation).
2081 * @NL80211_ATTR_CSA_IES: Nested set of attributes containing the IE information
2082 *	for the time while performing a channel switch.
2083 * @NL80211_ATTR_CNTDWN_OFFS_BEACON: An array of offsets (u16) to the channel
2084 *	switch or color change counters in the beacons tail (%NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_TAIL).
2085 * @NL80211_ATTR_CNTDWN_OFFS_PRESP: An array of offsets (u16) to the channel
2086 *	switch or color change counters in the probe response (%NL80211_ATTR_PROBE_RESP).
2087 *
2088 * @NL80211_ATTR_RXMGMT_FLAGS: flags for nl80211_send_mgmt(), u32.
2089 *	As specified in the &enum nl80211_rxmgmt_flags.
2090 *
2091 * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORTED_CHANNELS: array of supported channels.
2092 *
2093 * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORTED_OPER_CLASSES: array of supported
2094 *      operating classes.
2095 *
2096 * @NL80211_ATTR_HANDLE_DFS: A flag indicating whether user space
2097 *	controls DFS operation in IBSS mode. If the flag is included in
2098 *	%NL80211_CMD_JOIN_IBSS request, the driver will allow use of DFS
2099 *	channels and reports radar events to userspace. Userspace is required
2100 *	to react to radar events, e.g. initiate a channel switch or leave the
2101 *	IBSS network.
2102 *
2103 * @NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_5_MHZ: A flag indicating that the device supports
2104 *	5 MHz channel bandwidth.
2105 * @NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_10_MHZ: A flag indicating that the device supports
2106 *	10 MHz channel bandwidth.
2107 *
2108 * @NL80211_ATTR_OPMODE_NOTIF: Operating mode field from Operating Mode
2109 *	Notification Element based on association request when used with
2110 *	%NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION or %NL80211_CMD_SET_STATION (only when
2111 *	%NL80211_FEATURE_FULL_AP_CLIENT_STATE is supported, or with TDLS);
2112 *	u8 attribute.
2113 *
2114 * @NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_ID: The vendor ID, either a 24-bit OUI or, if
2115 *	%NL80211_VENDOR_ID_IS_LINUX is set, a special Linux ID (not used yet)
2116 * @NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_SUBCMD: vendor sub-command
2117 * @NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA: data for the vendor command, if any; this
2118 *	attribute is also used for vendor command feature advertisement
2119 * @NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_EVENTS: used for event list advertising in the wiphy
2120 *	info, containing a nested array of possible events
2121 *
2122 * @NL80211_ATTR_QOS_MAP: IP DSCP mapping for Interworking QoS mapping. This
2123 *	data is in the format defined for the payload of the QoS Map Set element
2124 *	in IEEE Std 802.11-2012, 8.4.2.97.
2125 *
2126 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAC_HINT: MAC address recommendation as initial BSS
2127 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_HINT: frequency of the recommended initial BSS
2128 *
2129 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_AP_ASSOC_STA: Device attribute that indicates how many
2130 *	associated stations are supported in AP mode (including P2P GO); u32.
2131 *	Since drivers may not have a fixed limit on the maximum number (e.g.,
2132 *	other concurrent operations may affect this), drivers are allowed to
2133 *	advertise values that cannot always be met. In such cases, an attempt
2134 *	to add a new station entry with @NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION may fail.
2135 *
2136 * @NL80211_ATTR_CSA_C_OFFSETS_TX: An array of csa counter offsets (u16) which
2137 *	should be updated when the frame is transmitted.
2138 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_CSA_COUNTERS: U8 attribute used to advertise the maximum
2139 *	supported number of csa counters.
2140 *
2141 * @NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_PEER_CAPABILITY: flags for TDLS peer capabilities, u32.
2142 *	As specified in the &enum nl80211_tdls_peer_capability.
2143 *
2144 * @NL80211_ATTR_SOCKET_OWNER: Flag attribute, if set during interface
2145 *	creation then the new interface will be owned by the netlink socket
2146 *	that created it and will be destroyed when the socket is closed.
2147 *	If set during scheduled scan start then the new scan req will be
2148 *	owned by the netlink socket that created it and the scheduled scan will
2149 *	be stopped when the socket is closed.
2150 *	If set during configuration of regulatory indoor operation then the
2151 *	regulatory indoor configuration would be owned by the netlink socket
2152 *	that configured the indoor setting, and the indoor operation would be
2153 *	cleared when the socket is closed.
2154 *	If set during NAN interface creation, the interface will be destroyed
2155 *	if the socket is closed just like any other interface. Moreover, NAN
2156 *	notifications will be sent in unicast to that socket. Without this
2157 *	attribute, the notifications will be sent to the %NL80211_MCGRP_NAN
2158 *	multicast group.
2159 *	If set during %NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE or %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT the
2160 *	station will deauthenticate when the socket is closed.
2161 *	If set during %NL80211_CMD_JOIN_IBSS the IBSS will be automatically
2162 *	torn down when the socket is closed.
2163 *	If set during %NL80211_CMD_JOIN_MESH the mesh setup will be
2164 *	automatically torn down when the socket is closed.
2165 *	If set during %NL80211_CMD_START_AP the AP will be automatically
2166 *	disabled when the socket is closed.
2167 *
2168 * @NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_INITIATOR: flag attribute indicating the current end is
2169 *	the TDLS link initiator.
2170 *
2171 * @NL80211_ATTR_USE_RRM: flag for indicating whether the current connection
2172 *	shall support Radio Resource Measurements (11k). This attribute can be
2173 *	used with %NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE and %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT requests.
2174 *	User space applications are expected to use this flag only if the
2175 *	underlying device supports these minimal RRM features:
2176 *		%NL80211_FEATURE_DS_PARAM_SET_IE_IN_PROBES,
2177 *		%NL80211_FEATURE_QUIET,
2178 *	Or, if global RRM is supported, see:
2179 *		%NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_RRM
2180 *	If this flag is used, driver must add the Power Capabilities IE to the
2181 *	association request. In addition, it must also set the RRM capability
2182 *	flag in the association request's Capability Info field.
2183 *
2184 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_DYN_ACK: flag attribute used to enable ACK timeout
2185 *	estimation algorithm (dynack). In order to activate dynack
2186 *	%NL80211_FEATURE_ACKTO_ESTIMATION feature flag must be set by lower
2187 *	drivers to indicate dynack capability. Dynack is automatically disabled
2188 *	setting valid value for coverage class.
2189 *
2190 * @NL80211_ATTR_TSID: a TSID value (u8 attribute)
2191 * @NL80211_ATTR_USER_PRIO: user priority value (u8 attribute)
2192 * @NL80211_ATTR_ADMITTED_TIME: admitted time in units of 32 microseconds
2193 *	(per second) (u16 attribute)
2194 *
2195 * @NL80211_ATTR_SMPS_MODE: SMPS mode to use (ap mode). see
2196 *	&enum nl80211_smps_mode.
2197 *
2198 * @NL80211_ATTR_OPER_CLASS: operating class
2199 *
2200 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAC_MASK: MAC address mask
2201 *
2202 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_SELF_MANAGED_REG: flag attribute indicating this device
2203 *	is self-managing its regulatory information and any regulatory domain
2204 *	obtained from it is coming from the device's wiphy and not the global
2205 *	cfg80211 regdomain.
2206 *
2207 * @NL80211_ATTR_EXT_FEATURES: extended feature flags contained in a byte
2208 *	array. The feature flags are identified by their bit index (see &enum
2209 *	nl80211_ext_feature_index). The bit index is ordered starting at the
2210 *	least-significant bit of the first byte in the array, ie. bit index 0
2211 *	is located at bit 0 of byte 0. bit index 25 would be located at bit 1
2212 *	of byte 3 (u8 array).
2213 *
2214 * @NL80211_ATTR_SURVEY_RADIO_STATS: Request overall radio statistics to be
2215 *	returned along with other survey data. If set, @NL80211_CMD_GET_SURVEY
2216 *	may return a survey entry without a channel indicating global radio
2217 *	statistics (only some values are valid and make sense.)
2218 *	For devices that don't return such an entry even then, the information
2219 *	should be contained in the result as the sum of the respective counters
2220 *	over all channels.
2221 *
2222 * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_DELAY: delay before the first cycle of a
2223 *	scheduled scan is started.  Or the delay before a WoWLAN
2224 *	net-detect scan is started, counting from the moment the
2225 *	system is suspended.  This value is a u32, in seconds.
2226
2227 * @NL80211_ATTR_REG_INDOOR: flag attribute, if set indicates that the device
2228 *      is operating in an indoor environment.
2229 *
2230 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_SCHED_SCAN_PLANS: maximum number of scan plans for
2231 *	scheduled scan supported by the device (u32), a wiphy attribute.
2232 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCAN_PLAN_INTERVAL: maximum interval (in seconds) for
2233 *	a scan plan (u32), a wiphy attribute.
2234 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCAN_PLAN_ITERATIONS: maximum number of iterations in
2235 *	a scan plan (u32), a wiphy attribute.
2236 * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_PLANS: a list of scan plans for scheduled scan.
2237 *	Each scan plan defines the number of scan iterations and the interval
2238 *	between scans. The last scan plan will always run infinitely,
2239 *	thus it must not specify the number of iterations, only the interval
2240 *	between scans. The scan plans are executed sequentially.
2241 *	Each scan plan is a nested attribute of &enum nl80211_sched_scan_plan.
2242 * @NL80211_ATTR_PBSS: flag attribute. If set it means operate
2243 *	in a PBSS. Specified in %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT to request
2244 *	connecting to a PCP, and in %NL80211_CMD_START_AP to start
2245 *	a PCP instead of AP. Relevant for DMG networks only.
2246 * @NL80211_ATTR_BSS_SELECT: nested attribute for driver supporting the
2247 *	BSS selection feature. When used with %NL80211_CMD_GET_WIPHY it contains
2248 *	attributes according &enum nl80211_bss_select_attr to indicate what
2249 *	BSS selection behaviours are supported. When used with %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT
2250 *	it contains the behaviour-specific attribute containing the parameters for
2251 *	BSS selection to be done by driver and/or firmware.
2252 *
2253 * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORT_P2P_PS: whether P2P PS mechanism supported
2254 *	or not. u8, one of the values of &enum nl80211_sta_p2p_ps_status
2255 *
2256 * @NL80211_ATTR_PAD: attribute used for padding for 64-bit alignment
2257 *
2258 * @NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE_EXT_CAPA: Nested attribute of the following attributes:
2259 *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE, %NL80211_ATTR_EXT_CAPA,
2260 *	%NL80211_ATTR_EXT_CAPA_MASK, to specify the extended capabilities per
2261 *	interface type.
2262 *
2263 * @NL80211_ATTR_MU_MIMO_GROUP_DATA: array of 24 bytes that defines a MU-MIMO
2264 *	groupID for monitor mode.
2265 *	The first 8 bytes are a mask that defines the membership in each
2266 *	group (there are 64 groups, group 0 and 63 are reserved),
2267 *	each bit represents a group and set to 1 for being a member in
2268 *	that group and 0 for not being a member.
2269 *	The remaining 16 bytes define the position in each group: 2 bits for
2270 *	each group.
2271 *	(smaller group numbers represented on most significant bits and bigger
2272 *	group numbers on least significant bits.)
2273 *	This attribute is used only if all interfaces are in monitor mode.
2274 *	Set this attribute in order to monitor packets using the given MU-MIMO
2275 *	groupID data.
2276 *	to turn off that feature set all the bits of the groupID to zero.
2277 * @NL80211_ATTR_MU_MIMO_FOLLOW_MAC_ADDR: mac address for the sniffer to follow
2278 *	when using MU-MIMO air sniffer.
2279 *	to turn that feature off set an invalid mac address
2280 *	(e.g. FF:FF:FF:FF:FF:FF)
2281 *
2282 * @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_START_TIME_TSF: The time at which the scan was actually
2283 *	started (u64). The time is the TSF of the BSS the interface that
2284 *	requested the scan is connected to (if available, otherwise this
2285 *	attribute must not be included).
2286 * @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_START_TIME_TSF_BSSID: The BSS according to which
2287 *	%NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_START_TIME_TSF is set.
2288 * @NL80211_ATTR_MEASUREMENT_DURATION: measurement duration in TUs (u16). If
2289 *	%NL80211_ATTR_MEASUREMENT_DURATION_MANDATORY is not set, this is the
2290 *	maximum measurement duration allowed. This attribute is used with
2291 *	measurement requests. It can also be used with %NL80211_CMD_TRIGGER_SCAN
2292 *	if the scan is used for beacon report radio measurement.
2293 * @NL80211_ATTR_MEASUREMENT_DURATION_MANDATORY: flag attribute that indicates
2294 *	that the duration specified with %NL80211_ATTR_MEASUREMENT_DURATION is
2295 *	mandatory. If this flag is not set, the duration is the maximum duration
2296 *	and the actual measurement duration may be shorter.
2297 *
2298 * @NL80211_ATTR_MESH_PEER_AID: Association ID for the mesh peer (u16). This is
2299 *	used to pull the stored data for mesh peer in power save state.
2300 *
2301 * @NL80211_ATTR_NAN_MASTER_PREF: the master preference to be used by
2302 *	%NL80211_CMD_START_NAN and optionally with
2303 *	%NL80211_CMD_CHANGE_NAN_CONFIG. Its type is u8 and it can't be 0.
2304 *	Also, values 1 and 255 are reserved for certification purposes and
2305 *	should not be used during a normal device operation.
2306 * @NL80211_ATTR_BANDS: operating bands configuration.  This is a u32
2307 *	bitmask of BIT(NL80211_BAND_*) as described in %enum
2308 *	nl80211_band.  For instance, for NL80211_BAND_2GHZ, bit 0
2309 *	would be set.  This attribute is used with
2310 *	%NL80211_CMD_START_NAN and %NL80211_CMD_CHANGE_NAN_CONFIG, and
2311 *	it is optional.  If no bands are set, it means don't-care and
2312 *	the device will decide what to use.
2313 * @NL80211_ATTR_NAN_FUNC: a function that can be added to NAN. See
2314 *	&enum nl80211_nan_func_attributes for description of this nested
2315 *	attribute.
2316 * @NL80211_ATTR_NAN_MATCH: used to report a match. This is a nested attribute.
2317 *	See &enum nl80211_nan_match_attributes.
2318 * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_KEK: KEK for FILS (Re)Association Request/Response frame
2319 *	protection.
2320 * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_NONCES: Nonces (part of AAD) for FILS (Re)Association
2321 *	Request/Response frame protection. This attribute contains the 16 octet
2322 *	STA Nonce followed by 16 octets of AP Nonce.
2323 *
2324 * @NL80211_ATTR_MULTICAST_TO_UNICAST_ENABLED: Indicates whether or not multicast
2325 *	packets should be send out as unicast to all stations (flag attribute).
2326 *
2327 * @NL80211_ATTR_BSSID: The BSSID of the AP. Note that %NL80211_ATTR_MAC is also
2328 *	used in various commands/events for specifying the BSSID.
2329 *
2330 * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_RELATIVE_RSSI: Relative RSSI threshold by which
2331 *	other BSSs has to be better or slightly worse than the current
2332 *	connected BSS so that they get reported to user space.
2333 *	This will give an opportunity to userspace to consider connecting to
2334 *	other matching BSSs which have better or slightly worse RSSI than
2335 *	the current connected BSS by using an offloaded operation to avoid
2336 *	unnecessary wakeups.
2337 *
2338 * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_RSSI_ADJUST: When present the RSSI level for BSSs in
2339 *	the specified band is to be adjusted before doing
2340 *	%NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_RELATIVE_RSSI based comparison to figure out
2341 *	better BSSs. The attribute value is a packed structure
2342 *	value as specified by &struct nl80211_bss_select_rssi_adjust.
2343 *
2344 * @NL80211_ATTR_TIMEOUT_REASON: The reason for which an operation timed out.
2345 *	u32 attribute with an &enum nl80211_timeout_reason value. This is used,
2346 *	e.g., with %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT event.
2347 *
2348 * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_USERNAME: EAP Re-authentication Protocol (ERP)
2349 *	username part of NAI used to refer keys rRK and rIK. This is used with
2350 *	%NL80211_CMD_CONNECT.
2351 *
2352 * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_REALM: EAP Re-authentication Protocol (ERP) realm part
2353 *	of NAI specifying the domain name of the ER server. This is used with
2354 *	%NL80211_CMD_CONNECT.
2355 *
2356 * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_NEXT_SEQ_NUM: Unsigned 16-bit ERP next sequence number
2357 *	to use in ERP messages. This is used in generating the FILS wrapped data
2358 *	for FILS authentication and is used with %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT.
2359 *
2360 * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_RRK: ERP re-authentication Root Key (rRK) for the
2361 *	NAI specified by %NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_USERNAME and
2362 *	%NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_REALM. This is used for generating rIK and rMSK
2363 *	from successful FILS authentication and is used with
2364 *	%NL80211_CMD_CONNECT.
2365 *
2366 * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_CACHE_ID: A 2-octet identifier advertized by a FILS AP
2367 *	identifying the scope of PMKSAs. This is used with
2368 *	@NL80211_CMD_SET_PMKSA and @NL80211_CMD_DEL_PMKSA.
2369 *
2370 * @NL80211_ATTR_PMK: attribute for passing PMK key material. Used with
2371 *	%NL80211_CMD_SET_PMKSA for the PMKSA identified by %NL80211_ATTR_PMKID.
2372 *	For %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT and %NL80211_CMD_START_AP it is used to provide
2373 *	PSK for offloading 4-way handshake for WPA/WPA2-PSK networks. For 802.1X
2374 *	authentication it is used with %NL80211_CMD_SET_PMK. For offloaded FT
2375 *	support this attribute specifies the PMK-R0 if NL80211_ATTR_PMKR0_NAME
2376 *	is included as well.
2377 *
2378 * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MULTI: flag attribute which user-space shall use to
2379 *	indicate that it supports multiple active scheduled scan requests.
2380 * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MAX_REQS: indicates maximum number of scheduled
2381 *	scan request that may be active for the device (u32).
2382 *
2383 * @NL80211_ATTR_WANT_1X_4WAY_HS: flag attribute which user-space can include
2384 *	in %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT to indicate that for 802.1X authentication it
2385 *	wants to use the supported offload of the 4-way handshake.
2386 * @NL80211_ATTR_PMKR0_NAME: PMK-R0 Name for offloaded FT.
2387 * @NL80211_ATTR_PORT_AUTHORIZED: (reserved)
2388 *
2389 * @NL80211_ATTR_EXTERNAL_AUTH_ACTION: Identify the requested external
2390 *     authentication operation (u32 attribute with an
2391 *     &enum nl80211_external_auth_action value). This is used with the
2392 *     %NL80211_CMD_EXTERNAL_AUTH request event.
2393 * @NL80211_ATTR_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT: Flag attribute indicating that the user
2394 *	space supports external authentication. This attribute shall be used
2395 *	with %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT and %NL80211_CMD_START_AP request. The driver
2396 *	may offload authentication processing to user space if this capability
2397 *	is indicated in the respective requests from the user space.
2398 *
2399 * @NL80211_ATTR_NSS: Station's New/updated  RX_NSS value notified using this
2400 *	u8 attribute. This is used with %NL80211_CMD_STA_OPMODE_CHANGED.
2401 *
2402 * @NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_STATS: TXQ statistics (nested attribute, see &enum
2403 *      nl80211_txq_stats)
2404 * @NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_LIMIT: Total packet limit for the TXQ queues for this phy.
2405 *      The smaller of this and the memory limit is enforced.
2406 * @NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_MEMORY_LIMIT: Total memory limit (in bytes) for the
2407 *      TXQ queues for this phy. The smaller of this and the packet limit is
2408 *      enforced.
2409 * @NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_QUANTUM: TXQ scheduler quantum (bytes). Number of bytes
2410 *      a flow is assigned on each round of the DRR scheduler.
2411 * @NL80211_ATTR_HE_CAPABILITY: HE Capability information element (from
2412 *	association request when used with NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION). Can be set
2413 *	only if %NL80211_STA_FLAG_WME is set.
2414 *
2415 * @NL80211_ATTR_FTM_RESPONDER: nested attribute which user-space can include
2416 *	in %NL80211_CMD_START_AP or %NL80211_CMD_SET_BEACON for fine timing
2417 *	measurement (FTM) responder functionality and containing parameters as
2418 *	possible, see &enum nl80211_ftm_responder_attr
2419 *
2420 * @NL80211_ATTR_FTM_RESPONDER_STATS: Nested attribute with FTM responder
2421 *	statistics, see &enum nl80211_ftm_responder_stats.
2422 *
2423 * @NL80211_ATTR_TIMEOUT: Timeout for the given operation in milliseconds (u32),
2424 *	if the attribute is not given no timeout is requested. Note that 0 is an
2425 *	invalid value.
2426 *
2427 * @NL80211_ATTR_PEER_MEASUREMENTS: peer measurements request (and result)
2428 *	data, uses nested attributes specified in
2429 *	&enum nl80211_peer_measurement_attrs.
2430 *	This is also used for capability advertisement in the wiphy information,
2431 *	with the appropriate sub-attributes.
2432 *
2433 * @NL80211_ATTR_AIRTIME_WEIGHT: Station's weight when scheduled by the airtime
2434 *	scheduler.
2435 *
2436 * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_TX_POWER_SETTING: Transmit power setting type (u8) for
2437 *	station associated with the AP. See &enum nl80211_tx_power_setting for
2438 *	possible values.
2439 * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_TX_POWER: Transmit power level (s16) in dBm units. This
2440 *	allows to set Tx power for a station. If this attribute is not included,
2441 *	the default per-interface tx power setting will be overriding. Driver
2442 *	should be picking up the lowest tx power, either tx power per-interface
2443 *	or per-station.
2444 *
2445 * @NL80211_ATTR_SAE_PASSWORD: attribute for passing SAE password material. It
2446 *	is used with %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT to provide password for offloading
2447 *	SAE authentication for WPA3-Personal networks.
2448 *
2449 * @NL80211_ATTR_TWT_RESPONDER: Enable target wait time responder support.
2450 *
2451 * @NL80211_ATTR_HE_OBSS_PD: nested attribute for OBSS Packet Detection
2452 *	functionality.
2453 *
2454 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_EDMG_CHANNELS: bitmap that indicates the 2.16 GHz
2455 *	channel(s) that are allowed to be used for EDMG transmissions.
2456 *	Defined by IEEE P802.11ay/D4.0 section 9.4.2.251. (u8 attribute)
2457 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_EDMG_BW_CONFIG: Channel BW Configuration subfield encodes
2458 *	the allowed channel bandwidth configurations. (u8 attribute)
2459 *	Defined by IEEE P802.11ay/D4.0 section 9.4.2.251, Table 13.
2460 *
2461 * @NL80211_ATTR_VLAN_ID: VLAN ID (1..4094) for the station and VLAN group key
2462 *	(u16).
2463 *
2464 * @NL80211_ATTR_HE_BSS_COLOR: nested attribute for BSS Color Settings.
2465 *
2466 * @NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE_AKM_SUITES: nested array attribute, with each entry
2467 *	using attributes from &enum nl80211_iftype_akm_attributes. This
2468 *	attribute is sent in a response to %NL80211_CMD_GET_WIPHY indicating
2469 *	supported AKM suites capability per interface. AKMs advertised in
2470 *	%NL80211_ATTR_AKM_SUITES are default capabilities if AKM suites not
2471 *	advertised for a specific interface type.
2472 *
2473 * @NL80211_ATTR_TID_CONFIG: TID specific configuration in a
2474 *	nested attribute with &enum nl80211_tid_config_attr sub-attributes;
2475 *	on output (in wiphy attributes) it contains only the feature sub-
2476 *	attributes.
2477 *
2478 * @NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_NO_PREAUTH: disable preauth frame rx on control
2479 *	port in order to forward/receive them as ordinary data frames.
2480 *
2481 * @NL80211_ATTR_PMK_LIFETIME: Maximum lifetime for PMKSA in seconds (u32,
2482 *	dot11RSNAConfigPMKReauthThreshold; 0 is not a valid value).
2483 *	An optional parameter configured through %NL80211_CMD_SET_PMKSA.
2484 *	Drivers that trigger roaming need to know the lifetime of the
2485 *	configured PMKSA for triggering the full vs. PMKSA caching based
2486 *	authentication. This timeout helps authentication methods like SAE,
2487 *	where PMK gets updated only by going through a full (new SAE)
2488 *	authentication instead of getting updated during an association for EAP
2489 *	authentication. No new full authentication within the PMK expiry shall
2490 *	result in a disassociation at the end of the lifetime.
2491 *
2492 * @NL80211_ATTR_PMK_REAUTH_THRESHOLD: Reauthentication threshold time, in
2493 *	terms of percentage of %NL80211_ATTR_PMK_LIFETIME
2494 *	(u8, dot11RSNAConfigPMKReauthThreshold, 1..100). This is an optional
2495 *	parameter configured through %NL80211_CMD_SET_PMKSA. Requests the
2496 *	driver to trigger a full authentication roam (without PMKSA caching)
2497 *	after the reauthentication threshold time, but before the PMK lifetime
2498 *	has expired.
2499 *
2500 *	Authentication methods like SAE need to be able to generate a new PMKSA
2501 *	entry without having to force a disconnection after the PMK timeout. If
2502 *	no roaming occurs between the reauth threshold and PMK expiration,
2503 *	disassociation is still forced.
2504 * @NL80211_ATTR_RECEIVE_MULTICAST: multicast flag for the
2505 *	%NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_FRAME command, see the description there.
2506 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_OFFSET: offset of the associated
2507 *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ in positive KHz. Only valid when supplied with
2508 *	an %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_OFFSET.
2509 * @NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1_OFFSET: Center frequency offset in KHz for the
2510 *	first channel segment specified in %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1.
2511 * @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQ_KHZ: nested attribute with KHz frequencies
2512 *
2513 * @NL80211_ATTR_HE_6GHZ_CAPABILITY: HE 6 GHz Band Capability element (from
2514 *	association request when used with NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION).
2515 *
2516 * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_DISCOVERY: Optional parameter to configure FILS
2517 *	discovery. It is a nested attribute, see
2518 *	&enum nl80211_fils_discovery_attributes.
2519 *
2520 * @NL80211_ATTR_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP: Optional parameter to configure
2521 *	unsolicited broadcast probe response. It is a nested attribute, see
2522 *	&enum nl80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp_attributes.
2523 *
2524 * @NL80211_ATTR_S1G_CAPABILITY: S1G Capability information element (from
2525 *	association request when used with NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION)
2526 * @NL80211_ATTR_S1G_CAPABILITY_MASK: S1G Capability Information element
2527 *	override mask. Used with NL80211_ATTR_S1G_CAPABILITY in
2528 *	NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE or NL80211_CMD_CONNECT.
2529 *
2530 * @NUM_NL80211_ATTR: total number of nl80211_attrs available
2531 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute number currently defined
2532 * @__NL80211_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use
2533 */
2534enum nl80211_attrs {
2535/* don't change the order or add anything between, this is ABI! */
2536	NL80211_ATTR_UNSPEC,
2537
2538	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY,
2539	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_NAME,
2540
2541	NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX,
2542	NL80211_ATTR_IFNAME,
2543	NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE,
2544
2545	NL80211_ATTR_MAC,
2546
2547	NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DATA,
2548	NL80211_ATTR_KEY_IDX,
2549	NL80211_ATTR_KEY_CIPHER,
2550	NL80211_ATTR_KEY_SEQ,
2551	NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT,
2552
2553	NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_INTERVAL,
2554	NL80211_ATTR_DTIM_PERIOD,
2555	NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_HEAD,
2556	NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_TAIL,
2557
2558	NL80211_ATTR_STA_AID,
2559	NL80211_ATTR_STA_FLAGS,
2560	NL80211_ATTR_STA_LISTEN_INTERVAL,
2561	NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORTED_RATES,
2562	NL80211_ATTR_STA_VLAN,
2563	NL80211_ATTR_STA_INFO,
2564
2565	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_BANDS,
2566
2567	NL80211_ATTR_MNTR_FLAGS,
2568
2569	NL80211_ATTR_MESH_ID,
2570	NL80211_ATTR_STA_PLINK_ACTION,
2571	NL80211_ATTR_MPATH_NEXT_HOP,
2572	NL80211_ATTR_MPATH_INFO,
2573
2574	NL80211_ATTR_BSS_CTS_PROT,
2575	NL80211_ATTR_BSS_SHORT_PREAMBLE,
2576	NL80211_ATTR_BSS_SHORT_SLOT_TIME,
2577
2578	NL80211_ATTR_HT_CAPABILITY,
2579
2580	NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORTED_IFTYPES,
2581
2582	NL80211_ATTR_REG_ALPHA2,
2583	NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULES,
2584
2585	NL80211_ATTR_MESH_CONFIG,
2586
2587	NL80211_ATTR_BSS_BASIC_RATES,
2588
2589	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TXQ_PARAMS,
2590	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ,
2591	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_CHANNEL_TYPE,
2592
2593	NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT_MGMT,
2594
2595	NL80211_ATTR_MGMT_SUBTYPE,
2596	NL80211_ATTR_IE,
2597
2598	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_SCAN_SSIDS,
2599
2600	NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQUENCIES,
2601	NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_SSIDS,
2602	NL80211_ATTR_GENERATION, /* replaces old SCAN_GENERATION */
2603	NL80211_ATTR_BSS,
2604
2605	NL80211_ATTR_REG_INITIATOR,
2606	NL80211_ATTR_REG_TYPE,
2607
2608	NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORTED_COMMANDS,
2609
2610	NL80211_ATTR_FRAME,
2611	NL80211_ATTR_SSID,
2612	NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_TYPE,
2613	NL80211_ATTR_REASON_CODE,
2614
2615	NL80211_ATTR_KEY_TYPE,
2616
2617	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCAN_IE_LEN,
2618	NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITES,
2619
2620	NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_BEFORE,
2621	NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_AFTER,
2622
2623	NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_FIXED,
2624
2625
2626	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RETRY_SHORT,
2627	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RETRY_LONG,
2628	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FRAG_THRESHOLD,
2629	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RTS_THRESHOLD,
2630
2631	NL80211_ATTR_TIMED_OUT,
2632
2633	NL80211_ATTR_USE_MFP,
2634
2635	NL80211_ATTR_STA_FLAGS2,
2636
2637	NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT,
2638
2639	NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA,
2640
2641	NL80211_ATTR_PRIVACY,
2642
2643	NL80211_ATTR_DISCONNECTED_BY_AP,
2644	NL80211_ATTR_STATUS_CODE,
2645
2646	NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITES_PAIRWISE,
2647	NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITE_GROUP,
2648	NL80211_ATTR_WPA_VERSIONS,
2649	NL80211_ATTR_AKM_SUITES,
2650
2651	NL80211_ATTR_REQ_IE,
2652	NL80211_ATTR_RESP_IE,
2653
2654	NL80211_ATTR_PREV_BSSID,
2655
2656	NL80211_ATTR_KEY,
2657	NL80211_ATTR_KEYS,
2658
2659	NL80211_ATTR_PID,
2660
2661	NL80211_ATTR_4ADDR,
2662
2663	NL80211_ATTR_SURVEY_INFO,
2664
2665	NL80211_ATTR_PMKID,
2666	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_PMKIDS,
2667
2668	NL80211_ATTR_DURATION,
2669
2670	NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE,
2671
2672	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_COVERAGE_CLASS,
2673
2674	NL80211_ATTR_TX_RATES,
2675
2676	NL80211_ATTR_FRAME_MATCH,
2677
2678	NL80211_ATTR_ACK,
2679
2680	NL80211_ATTR_PS_STATE,
2681
2682	NL80211_ATTR_CQM,
2683
2684	NL80211_ATTR_LOCAL_STATE_CHANGE,
2685
2686	NL80211_ATTR_AP_ISOLATE,
2687
2688	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TX_POWER_SETTING,
2689	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TX_POWER_LEVEL,
2690
2691	NL80211_ATTR_TX_FRAME_TYPES,
2692	NL80211_ATTR_RX_FRAME_TYPES,
2693	NL80211_ATTR_FRAME_TYPE,
2694
2695	NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_ETHERTYPE,
2696	NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_NO_ENCRYPT,
2697
2698	NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_IBSS_RSN,
2699
2700	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_TX,
2701	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_RX,
2702
2703	NL80211_ATTR_MCAST_RATE,
2704
2705	NL80211_ATTR_OFFCHANNEL_TX_OK,
2706
2707	NL80211_ATTR_BSS_HT_OPMODE,
2708
2709	NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPES,
2710
2711	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL_DURATION,
2712
2713	NL80211_ATTR_MESH_SETUP,
2714
2715	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_AVAIL_TX,
2716	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_AVAIL_RX,
2717
2718	NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_MESH_AUTH,
2719	NL80211_ATTR_STA_PLINK_STATE,
2720
2721	NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS,
2722	NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS_SUPPORTED,
2723
2724	NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_INTERVAL,
2725
2726	NL80211_ATTR_INTERFACE_COMBINATIONS,
2727	NL80211_ATTR_SOFTWARE_IFTYPES,
2728
2729	NL80211_ATTR_REKEY_DATA,
2730
2731	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_SCHED_SCAN_SSIDS,
2732	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCHED_SCAN_IE_LEN,
2733
2734	NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_SUPP_RATES,
2735
2736	NL80211_ATTR_HIDDEN_SSID,
2737
2738	NL80211_ATTR_IE_PROBE_RESP,
2739	NL80211_ATTR_IE_ASSOC_RESP,
2740
2741	NL80211_ATTR_STA_WME,
2742	NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_AP_UAPSD,
2743
2744	NL80211_ATTR_ROAM_SUPPORT,
2745
2746	NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH,
2747	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_MATCH_SETS,
2748
2749	NL80211_ATTR_PMKSA_CANDIDATE,
2750
2751	NL80211_ATTR_TX_NO_CCK_RATE,
2752
2753	NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_ACTION,
2754	NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_DIALOG_TOKEN,
2755	NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_OPERATION,
2756	NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_SUPPORT,
2757	NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_EXTERNAL_SETUP,
2758
2759	NL80211_ATTR_DEVICE_AP_SME,
2760
2761	NL80211_ATTR_DONT_WAIT_FOR_ACK,
2762
2763	NL80211_ATTR_FEATURE_FLAGS,
2764
2765	NL80211_ATTR_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD,
2766
2767	NL80211_ATTR_PROBE_RESP,
2768
2769	NL80211_ATTR_DFS_REGION,
2770
2771	NL80211_ATTR_DISABLE_HT,
2772	NL80211_ATTR_HT_CAPABILITY_MASK,
2773
2774	NL80211_ATTR_NOACK_MAP,
2775
2776	NL80211_ATTR_INACTIVITY_TIMEOUT,
2777
2778	NL80211_ATTR_RX_SIGNAL_DBM,
2779
2780	NL80211_ATTR_BG_SCAN_PERIOD,
2781
2782	NL80211_ATTR_WDEV,
2783
2784	NL80211_ATTR_USER_REG_HINT_TYPE,
2785
2786	NL80211_ATTR_CONN_FAILED_REASON,
2787
2788	NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_DATA,
2789
2790	NL80211_ATTR_VHT_CAPABILITY,
2791
2792	NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FLAGS,
2793
2794	NL80211_ATTR_CHANNEL_WIDTH,
2795	NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1,
2796	NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ2,
2797
2798	NL80211_ATTR_P2P_CTWINDOW,
2799	NL80211_ATTR_P2P_OPPPS,
2800
2801	NL80211_ATTR_LOCAL_MESH_POWER_MODE,
2802
2803	NL80211_ATTR_ACL_POLICY,
2804
2805	NL80211_ATTR_MAC_ADDRS,
2806
2807	NL80211_ATTR_MAC_ACL_MAX,
2808
2809	NL80211_ATTR_RADAR_EVENT,
2810
2811	NL80211_ATTR_EXT_CAPA,
2812	NL80211_ATTR_EXT_CAPA_MASK,
2813
2814	NL80211_ATTR_STA_CAPABILITY,
2815	NL80211_ATTR_STA_EXT_CAPABILITY,
2816
2817	NL80211_ATTR_PROTOCOL_FEATURES,
2818	NL80211_ATTR_SPLIT_WIPHY_DUMP,
2819
2820	NL80211_ATTR_DISABLE_VHT,
2821	NL80211_ATTR_VHT_CAPABILITY_MASK,
2822
2823	NL80211_ATTR_MDID,
2824	NL80211_ATTR_IE_RIC,
2825
2826	NL80211_ATTR_CRIT_PROT_ID,
2827	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_CRIT_PROT_DURATION,
2828
2829	NL80211_ATTR_PEER_AID,
2830
2831	NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE,
2832
2833	NL80211_ATTR_CH_SWITCH_COUNT,
2834	NL80211_ATTR_CH_SWITCH_BLOCK_TX,
2835	NL80211_ATTR_CSA_IES,
2836	NL80211_ATTR_CNTDWN_OFFS_BEACON,
2837	NL80211_ATTR_CNTDWN_OFFS_PRESP,
2838
2839	NL80211_ATTR_RXMGMT_FLAGS,
2840
2841	NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORTED_CHANNELS,
2842
2843	NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORTED_OPER_CLASSES,
2844
2845	NL80211_ATTR_HANDLE_DFS,
2846
2847	NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_5_MHZ,
2848	NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_10_MHZ,
2849
2850	NL80211_ATTR_OPMODE_NOTIF,
2851
2852	NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_ID,
2853	NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_SUBCMD,
2854	NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA,
2855	NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_EVENTS,
2856
2857	NL80211_ATTR_QOS_MAP,
2858
2859	NL80211_ATTR_MAC_HINT,
2860	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_HINT,
2861
2862	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_AP_ASSOC_STA,
2863
2864	NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_PEER_CAPABILITY,
2865
2866	NL80211_ATTR_SOCKET_OWNER,
2867
2868	NL80211_ATTR_CSA_C_OFFSETS_TX,
2869	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_CSA_COUNTERS,
2870
2871	NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_INITIATOR,
2872
2873	NL80211_ATTR_USE_RRM,
2874
2875	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_DYN_ACK,
2876
2877	NL80211_ATTR_TSID,
2878	NL80211_ATTR_USER_PRIO,
2879	NL80211_ATTR_ADMITTED_TIME,
2880
2881	NL80211_ATTR_SMPS_MODE,
2882
2883	NL80211_ATTR_OPER_CLASS,
2884
2885	NL80211_ATTR_MAC_MASK,
2886
2887	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_SELF_MANAGED_REG,
2888
2889	NL80211_ATTR_EXT_FEATURES,
2890
2891	NL80211_ATTR_SURVEY_RADIO_STATS,
2892
2893	NL80211_ATTR_NETNS_FD,
2894
2895	NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_DELAY,
2896
2897	NL80211_ATTR_REG_INDOOR,
2898
2899	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_SCHED_SCAN_PLANS,
2900	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCAN_PLAN_INTERVAL,
2901	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCAN_PLAN_ITERATIONS,
2902	NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_PLANS,
2903
2904	NL80211_ATTR_PBSS,
2905
2906	NL80211_ATTR_BSS_SELECT,
2907
2908	NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORT_P2P_PS,
2909
2910	NL80211_ATTR_PAD,
2911
2912	NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE_EXT_CAPA,
2913
2914	NL80211_ATTR_MU_MIMO_GROUP_DATA,
2915	NL80211_ATTR_MU_MIMO_FOLLOW_MAC_ADDR,
2916
2917	NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_START_TIME_TSF,
2918	NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_START_TIME_TSF_BSSID,
2919	NL80211_ATTR_MEASUREMENT_DURATION,
2920	NL80211_ATTR_MEASUREMENT_DURATION_MANDATORY,
2921
2922	NL80211_ATTR_MESH_PEER_AID,
2923
2924	NL80211_ATTR_NAN_MASTER_PREF,
2925	NL80211_ATTR_BANDS,
2926	NL80211_ATTR_NAN_FUNC,
2927	NL80211_ATTR_NAN_MATCH,
2928
2929	NL80211_ATTR_FILS_KEK,
2930	NL80211_ATTR_FILS_NONCES,
2931
2932	NL80211_ATTR_MULTICAST_TO_UNICAST_ENABLED,
2933
2934	NL80211_ATTR_BSSID,
2935
2936	NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_RELATIVE_RSSI,
2937	NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_RSSI_ADJUST,
2938
2939	NL80211_ATTR_TIMEOUT_REASON,
2940
2941	NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_USERNAME,
2942	NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_REALM,
2943	NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_NEXT_SEQ_NUM,
2944	NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_RRK,
2945	NL80211_ATTR_FILS_CACHE_ID,
2946
2947	NL80211_ATTR_PMK,
2948
2949	NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MULTI,
2950	NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MAX_REQS,
2951
2952	NL80211_ATTR_WANT_1X_4WAY_HS,
2953	NL80211_ATTR_PMKR0_NAME,
2954	NL80211_ATTR_PORT_AUTHORIZED,
2955
2956	NL80211_ATTR_EXTERNAL_AUTH_ACTION,
2957	NL80211_ATTR_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT,
2958
2959	NL80211_ATTR_NSS,
2960	NL80211_ATTR_ACK_SIGNAL,
2961
2962	NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_OVER_NL80211,
2963
2964	NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_STATS,
2965	NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_LIMIT,
2966	NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_MEMORY_LIMIT,
2967	NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_QUANTUM,
2968
2969	NL80211_ATTR_HE_CAPABILITY,
2970
2971	NL80211_ATTR_FTM_RESPONDER,
2972
2973	NL80211_ATTR_FTM_RESPONDER_STATS,
2974
2975	NL80211_ATTR_TIMEOUT,
2976
2977	NL80211_ATTR_PEER_MEASUREMENTS,
2978
2979	NL80211_ATTR_AIRTIME_WEIGHT,
2980	NL80211_ATTR_STA_TX_POWER_SETTING,
2981	NL80211_ATTR_STA_TX_POWER,
2982
2983	NL80211_ATTR_SAE_PASSWORD,
2984
2985	NL80211_ATTR_TWT_RESPONDER,
2986
2987	NL80211_ATTR_HE_OBSS_PD,
2988
2989	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_EDMG_CHANNELS,
2990	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_EDMG_BW_CONFIG,
2991
2992	NL80211_ATTR_VLAN_ID,
2993
2994	NL80211_ATTR_HE_BSS_COLOR,
2995
2996	NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE_AKM_SUITES,
2997
2998	NL80211_ATTR_TID_CONFIG,
2999
3000	NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_NO_PREAUTH,
3001
3002	NL80211_ATTR_PMK_LIFETIME,
3003	NL80211_ATTR_PMK_REAUTH_THRESHOLD,
3004
3005	NL80211_ATTR_RECEIVE_MULTICAST,
3006	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_OFFSET,
3007	NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1_OFFSET,
3008	NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQ_KHZ,
3009
3010	NL80211_ATTR_HE_6GHZ_CAPABILITY,
3011
3012	NL80211_ATTR_FILS_DISCOVERY,
3013
3014	NL80211_ATTR_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP,
3015
3016	NL80211_ATTR_S1G_CAPABILITY,
3017	NL80211_ATTR_S1G_CAPABILITY_MASK,
3018
3019	/* add attributes here, update the policy in nl80211.c */
3020
3021	__NL80211_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
3022	NUM_NL80211_ATTR = __NL80211_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
3023	NL80211_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
3024};
3025
3026/* source-level API compatibility */
3027#define NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_GENERATION NL80211_ATTR_GENERATION
3028#define	NL80211_ATTR_MESH_PARAMS NL80211_ATTR_MESH_CONFIG
3029#define NL80211_ATTR_IFACE_SOCKET_OWNER NL80211_ATTR_SOCKET_OWNER
3030#define NL80211_ATTR_SAE_DATA NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_DATA
3031#define NL80211_ATTR_CSA_C_OFF_BEACON NL80211_ATTR_CNTDWN_OFFS_BEACON
3032#define NL80211_ATTR_CSA_C_OFF_PRESP NL80211_ATTR_CNTDWN_OFFS_PRESP
3033
3034/*
3035 * Allow user space programs to use #ifdef on new attributes by defining them
3036 * here
3037 */
3038#define NL80211_CMD_CONNECT NL80211_CMD_CONNECT
3039#define NL80211_ATTR_HT_CAPABILITY NL80211_ATTR_HT_CAPABILITY
3040#define NL80211_ATTR_BSS_BASIC_RATES NL80211_ATTR_BSS_BASIC_RATES
3041#define NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TXQ_PARAMS NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TXQ_PARAMS
3042#define NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ
3043#define NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_CHANNEL_TYPE NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_CHANNEL_TYPE
3044#define NL80211_ATTR_MGMT_SUBTYPE NL80211_ATTR_MGMT_SUBTYPE
3045#define NL80211_ATTR_IE NL80211_ATTR_IE
3046#define NL80211_ATTR_REG_INITIATOR NL80211_ATTR_REG_INITIATOR
3047#define NL80211_ATTR_REG_TYPE NL80211_ATTR_REG_TYPE
3048#define NL80211_ATTR_FRAME NL80211_ATTR_FRAME
3049#define NL80211_ATTR_SSID NL80211_ATTR_SSID
3050#define NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_TYPE NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_TYPE
3051#define NL80211_ATTR_REASON_CODE NL80211_ATTR_REASON_CODE
3052#define NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITES_PAIRWISE NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITES_PAIRWISE
3053#define NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITE_GROUP NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITE_GROUP
3054#define NL80211_ATTR_WPA_VERSIONS NL80211_ATTR_WPA_VERSIONS
3055#define NL80211_ATTR_AKM_SUITES NL80211_ATTR_AKM_SUITES
3056#define NL80211_ATTR_KEY NL80211_ATTR_KEY
3057#define NL80211_ATTR_KEYS NL80211_ATTR_KEYS
3058#define NL80211_ATTR_FEATURE_FLAGS NL80211_ATTR_FEATURE_FLAGS
3059
3060#define NL80211_WIPHY_NAME_MAXLEN		64
3061
3062#define NL80211_MAX_SUPP_RATES			32
3063#define NL80211_MAX_SUPP_HT_RATES		77
3064#define NL80211_MAX_SUPP_REG_RULES		128
3065#define NL80211_TKIP_DATA_OFFSET_ENCR_KEY	0
3066#define NL80211_TKIP_DATA_OFFSET_TX_MIC_KEY	16
3067#define NL80211_TKIP_DATA_OFFSET_RX_MIC_KEY	24
3068#define NL80211_HT_CAPABILITY_LEN		26
3069#define NL80211_VHT_CAPABILITY_LEN		12
3070#define NL80211_HE_MIN_CAPABILITY_LEN           16
3071#define NL80211_HE_MAX_CAPABILITY_LEN           54
3072#define NL80211_MAX_NR_CIPHER_SUITES		5
3073#define NL80211_MAX_NR_AKM_SUITES		2
3074
3075#define NL80211_MIN_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL_TIME	10
3076
3077/* default RSSI threshold for scan results if none specified. */
3078#define NL80211_SCAN_RSSI_THOLD_OFF		-300
3079
3080#define NL80211_CQM_TXE_MAX_INTVL		1800
3081
3082/**
3083 * enum nl80211_iftype - (virtual) interface types
3084 *
3085 * @NL80211_IFTYPE_UNSPECIFIED: unspecified type, driver decides
3086 * @NL80211_IFTYPE_ADHOC: independent BSS member
3087 * @NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION: managed BSS member
3088 * @NL80211_IFTYPE_AP: access point
3089 * @NL80211_IFTYPE_AP_VLAN: VLAN interface for access points; VLAN interfaces
3090 *	are a bit special in that they must always be tied to a pre-existing
3091 *	AP type interface.
3092 * @NL80211_IFTYPE_WDS: wireless distribution interface
3093 * @NL80211_IFTYPE_MONITOR: monitor interface receiving all frames
3094 * @NL80211_IFTYPE_MESH_POINT: mesh point
3095 * @NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_CLIENT: P2P client
3096 * @NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO: P2P group owner
3097 * @NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_DEVICE: P2P device interface type, this is not a netdev
3098 *	and therefore can't be created in the normal ways, use the
3099 *	%NL80211_CMD_START_P2P_DEVICE and %NL80211_CMD_STOP_P2P_DEVICE
3100 *	commands to create and destroy one
3101 * @NL80211_IF_TYPE_OCB: Outside Context of a BSS
3102 *	This mode corresponds to the MIB variable dot11OCBActivated=true
3103 * @NL80211_IFTYPE_NAN: NAN device interface type (not a netdev)
3104 * @NL80211_IFTYPE_MAX: highest interface type number currently defined
3105 * @NUM_NL80211_IFTYPES: number of defined interface types
3106 *
3107 * These values are used with the %NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE
3108 * to set the type of an interface.
3109 *
3110 */
3111enum nl80211_iftype {
3112	NL80211_IFTYPE_UNSPECIFIED,
3113	NL80211_IFTYPE_ADHOC,
3114	NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION,
3115	NL80211_IFTYPE_AP,
3116	NL80211_IFTYPE_AP_VLAN,
3117	NL80211_IFTYPE_WDS,
3118	NL80211_IFTYPE_MONITOR,
3119	NL80211_IFTYPE_MESH_POINT,
3120	NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_CLIENT,
3121	NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO,
3122	NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_DEVICE,
3123	NL80211_IFTYPE_OCB,
3124	NL80211_IFTYPE_NAN,
3125
3126	/* keep last */
3127	NUM_NL80211_IFTYPES,
3128	NL80211_IFTYPE_MAX = NUM_NL80211_IFTYPES - 1
3129};
3130
3131/**
3132 * enum nl80211_sta_flags - station flags
3133 *
3134 * Station flags. When a station is added to an AP interface, it is
3135 * assumed to be already associated (and hence authenticated.)
3136 *
3137 * @__NL80211_STA_FLAG_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
3138 * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHORIZED: station is authorized (802.1X)
3139 * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_SHORT_PREAMBLE: station is capable of receiving frames
3140 *	with short barker preamble
3141 * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_WME: station is WME/QoS capable
3142 * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_MFP: station uses management frame protection
3143 * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHENTICATED: station is authenticated
3144 * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_TDLS_PEER: station is a TDLS peer -- this flag should
3145 *	only be used in managed mode (even in the flags mask). Note that the
3146 *	flag can't be changed, it is only valid while adding a station, and
3147 *	attempts to change it will silently be ignored (rather than rejected
3148 *	as errors.)
3149 * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_ASSOCIATED: station is associated; used with drivers
3150 *	that support %NL80211_FEATURE_FULL_AP_CLIENT_STATE to transition a
3151 *	previously added station into associated state
3152 * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_MAX: highest station flag number currently defined
3153 * @__NL80211_STA_FLAG_AFTER_LAST: internal use
3154 */
3155enum nl80211_sta_flags {
3156	__NL80211_STA_FLAG_INVALID,
3157	NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHORIZED,
3158	NL80211_STA_FLAG_SHORT_PREAMBLE,
3159	NL80211_STA_FLAG_WME,
3160	NL80211_STA_FLAG_MFP,
3161	NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHENTICATED,
3162	NL80211_STA_FLAG_TDLS_PEER,
3163	NL80211_STA_FLAG_ASSOCIATED,
3164
3165	/* keep last */
3166	__NL80211_STA_FLAG_AFTER_LAST,
3167	NL80211_STA_FLAG_MAX = __NL80211_STA_FLAG_AFTER_LAST - 1
3168};
3169
3170/**
3171 * enum nl80211_sta_p2p_ps_status - station support of P2P PS
3172 *
3173 * @NL80211_P2P_PS_UNSUPPORTED: station doesn't support P2P PS mechanism
3174 * @@NL80211_P2P_PS_SUPPORTED: station supports P2P PS mechanism
3175 * @NUM_NL80211_P2P_PS_STATUS: number of values
3176 */
3177enum nl80211_sta_p2p_ps_status {
3178	NL80211_P2P_PS_UNSUPPORTED = 0,
3179	NL80211_P2P_PS_SUPPORTED,
3180
3181	NUM_NL80211_P2P_PS_STATUS,
3182};
3183
3184#define NL80211_STA_FLAG_MAX_OLD_API	NL80211_STA_FLAG_TDLS_PEER
3185
3186/**
3187 * struct nl80211_sta_flag_update - station flags mask/set
3188 * @mask: mask of station flags to set
3189 * @set: which values to set them to
3190 *
3191 * Both mask and set contain bits as per &enum nl80211_sta_flags.
3192 */
3193struct nl80211_sta_flag_update {
3194	__u32 mask;
3195	__u32 set;
3196} __attribute__((packed));
3197
3198/**
3199 * enum nl80211_he_gi - HE guard interval
3200 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_GI_0_8: 0.8 usec
3201 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_GI_1_6: 1.6 usec
3202 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_GI_3_2: 3.2 usec
3203 */
3204enum nl80211_he_gi {
3205	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_GI_0_8,
3206	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_GI_1_6,
3207	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_GI_3_2,
3208};
3209
3210/**
3211 * enum nl80211_he_ltf - HE long training field
3212 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_1xLTF: 3.2 usec
3213 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_2xLTF: 6.4 usec
3214 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_4xLTF: 12.8 usec
3215 */
3216enum nl80211_he_ltf {
3217	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_1XLTF,
3218	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_2XLTF,
3219	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_4XLTF,
3220};
3221
3222/**
3223 * enum nl80211_he_ru_alloc - HE RU allocation values
3224 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_26: 26-tone RU allocation
3225 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_52: 52-tone RU allocation
3226 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_106: 106-tone RU allocation
3227 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_242: 242-tone RU allocation
3228 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_484: 484-tone RU allocation
3229 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_996: 996-tone RU allocation
3230 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_2x996: 2x996-tone RU allocation
3231 */
3232enum nl80211_he_ru_alloc {
3233	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_26,
3234	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_52,
3235	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_106,
3236	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_242,
3237	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_484,
3238	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_996,
3239	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_2x996,
3240};
3241
3242/**
3243 * enum nl80211_rate_info - bitrate information
3244 *
3245 * These attribute types are used with %NL80211_STA_INFO_TXRATE
3246 * when getting information about the bitrate of a station.
3247 * There are 2 attributes for bitrate, a legacy one that represents
3248 * a 16-bit value, and new one that represents a 32-bit value.
3249 * If the rate value fits into 16 bit, both attributes are reported
3250 * with the same value. If the rate is too high to fit into 16 bits
3251 * (>6.5535Gbps) only 32-bit attribute is included.
3252 * User space tools encouraged to use the 32-bit attribute and fall
3253 * back to the 16-bit one for compatibility with older kernels.
3254 *
3255 * @__NL80211_RATE_INFO_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
3256 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_BITRATE: total bitrate (u16, 100kbit/s)
3257 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_MCS: mcs index for 802.11n (u8)
3258 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_40_MHZ_WIDTH: 40 MHz dualchannel bitrate
3259 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_SHORT_GI: 400ns guard interval
3260 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_BITRATE32: total bitrate (u32, 100kbit/s)
3261 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_MAX: highest rate_info number currently defined
3262 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_VHT_MCS: MCS index for VHT (u8)
3263 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_VHT_NSS: number of streams in VHT (u8)
3264 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_80_MHZ_WIDTH: 80 MHz VHT rate
3265 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_80P80_MHZ_WIDTH: unused - 80+80 is treated the
3266 *	same as 160 for purposes of the bitrates
3267 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_160_MHZ_WIDTH: 160 MHz VHT rate
3268 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_10_MHZ_WIDTH: 10 MHz width - note that this is
3269 *	a legacy rate and will be reported as the actual bitrate, i.e.
3270 *	half the base (20 MHz) rate
3271 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_5_MHZ_WIDTH: 5 MHz width - note that this is
3272 *	a legacy rate and will be reported as the actual bitrate, i.e.
3273 *	a quarter of the base (20 MHz) rate
3274 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_MCS: HE MCS index (u8, 0-11)
3275 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_NSS: HE NSS value (u8, 1-8)
3276 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_GI: HE guard interval identifier
3277 *	(u8, see &enum nl80211_he_gi)
3278 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_DCM: HE DCM value (u8, 0/1)
3279 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_RU_ALLOC: HE RU allocation, if not present then
3280 *	non-OFDMA was used (u8, see &enum nl80211_he_ru_alloc)
3281 * @__NL80211_RATE_INFO_AFTER_LAST: internal use
3282 */
3283enum nl80211_rate_info {
3284	__NL80211_RATE_INFO_INVALID,
3285	NL80211_RATE_INFO_BITRATE,
3286	NL80211_RATE_INFO_MCS,
3287	NL80211_RATE_INFO_40_MHZ_WIDTH,
3288	NL80211_RATE_INFO_SHORT_GI,
3289	NL80211_RATE_INFO_BITRATE32,
3290	NL80211_RATE_INFO_VHT_MCS,
3291	NL80211_RATE_INFO_VHT_NSS,
3292	NL80211_RATE_INFO_80_MHZ_WIDTH,
3293	NL80211_RATE_INFO_80P80_MHZ_WIDTH,
3294	NL80211_RATE_INFO_160_MHZ_WIDTH,
3295	NL80211_RATE_INFO_10_MHZ_WIDTH,
3296	NL80211_RATE_INFO_5_MHZ_WIDTH,
3297	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_MCS,
3298	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_NSS,
3299	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_GI,
3300	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_DCM,
3301	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC,
3302
3303	/* keep last */
3304	__NL80211_RATE_INFO_AFTER_LAST,
3305	NL80211_RATE_INFO_MAX = __NL80211_RATE_INFO_AFTER_LAST - 1
3306};
3307
3308/**
3309 * enum nl80211_sta_bss_param - BSS information collected by STA
3310 *
3311 * These attribute types are used with %NL80211_STA_INFO_BSS_PARAM
3312 * when getting information about the bitrate of a station.
3313 *
3314 * @__NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
3315 * @NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_CTS_PROT: whether CTS protection is enabled (flag)
3316 * @NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_SHORT_PREAMBLE:  whether short preamble is enabled
3317 *	(flag)
3318 * @NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_SHORT_SLOT_TIME:  whether short slot time is enabled
3319 *	(flag)
3320 * @NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_DTIM_PERIOD: DTIM period for beaconing (u8)
3321 * @NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_BEACON_INTERVAL: Beacon interval (u16)
3322 * @NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_MAX: highest sta_bss_param number currently defined
3323 * @__NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_AFTER_LAST: internal use
3324 */
3325enum nl80211_sta_bss_param {
3326	__NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_INVALID,
3327	NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_CTS_PROT,
3328	NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_SHORT_PREAMBLE,
3329	NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_SHORT_SLOT_TIME,
3330	NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_DTIM_PERIOD,
3331	NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_BEACON_INTERVAL,
3332
3333	/* keep last */
3334	__NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_AFTER_LAST,
3335	NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_MAX = __NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_AFTER_LAST - 1
3336};
3337
3338/**
3339 * enum nl80211_sta_info - station information
3340 *
3341 * These attribute types are used with %NL80211_ATTR_STA_INFO
3342 * when getting information about a station.
3343 *
3344 * @__NL80211_STA_INFO_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
3345 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_INACTIVE_TIME: time since last activity (u32, msecs)
3346 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_BYTES: total received bytes (MPDU length)
3347 *	(u32, from this station)
3348 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_BYTES: total transmitted bytes (MPDU length)
3349 *	(u32, to this station)
3350 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_BYTES64: total received bytes (MPDU length)
3351 *	(u64, from this station)
3352 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_BYTES64: total transmitted bytes (MPDU length)
3353 *	(u64, to this station)
3354 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_SIGNAL: signal strength of last received PPDU (u8, dBm)
3355 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_BITRATE: current unicast tx rate, nested attribute
3356 * 	containing info as possible, see &enum nl80211_rate_info
3357 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_PACKETS: total received packet (MSDUs and MMPDUs)
3358 *	(u32, from this station)
3359 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_PACKETS: total transmitted packets (MSDUs and MMPDUs)
3360 *	(u32, to this station)
3361 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_RETRIES: total retries (MPDUs) (u32, to this station)
3362 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_FAILED: total failed packets (MPDUs)
3363 *	(u32, to this station)
3364 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_SIGNAL_AVG: signal strength average (u8, dBm)
3365 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_LLID: the station's mesh LLID
3366 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_PLID: the station's mesh PLID
3367 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_PLINK_STATE: peer link state for the station
3368 *	(see %enum nl80211_plink_state)
3369 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_BITRATE: last unicast data frame rx rate, nested
3370 *	attribute, like NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_BITRATE.
3371 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_BSS_PARAM: current station's view of BSS, nested attribute
3372 *     containing info as possible, see &enum nl80211_sta_bss_param
3373 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_CONNECTED_TIME: time since the station is last connected
3374 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_STA_FLAGS: Contains a struct nl80211_sta_flag_update.
3375 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_BEACON_LOSS: count of times beacon loss was detected (u32)
3376 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_T_OFFSET: timing offset with respect to this STA (s64)
3377 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_LOCAL_PM: local mesh STA link-specific power mode
3378 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_PEER_PM: peer mesh STA link-specific power mode
3379 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_NONPEER_PM: neighbor mesh STA power save mode towards
3380 *	non-peer STA
3381 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_CHAIN_SIGNAL: per-chain signal strength of last PPDU
3382 *	Contains a nested array of signal strength attributes (u8, dBm)
3383 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_CHAIN_SIGNAL_AVG: per-chain signal strength average
3384 *	Same format as NL80211_STA_INFO_CHAIN_SIGNAL.
3385 * @NL80211_STA_EXPECTED_THROUGHPUT: expected throughput considering also the
3386 *	802.11 header (u32, kbps)
3387 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_DROP_MISC: RX packets dropped for unspecified reasons
3388 *	(u64)
3389 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_BEACON_RX: number of beacons received from this peer (u64)
3390 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_BEACON_SIGNAL_AVG: signal strength average
3391 *	for beacons only (u8, dBm)
3392 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TID_STATS: per-TID statistics (see &enum nl80211_tid_stats)
3393 *	This is a nested attribute where each the inner attribute number is the
3394 *	TID+1 and the special TID 16 (i.e. value 17) is used for non-QoS frames;
3395 *	each one of those is again nested with &enum nl80211_tid_stats
3396 *	attributes carrying the actual values.
3397 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_DURATION: aggregate PPDU duration for all frames
3398 *	received from the station (u64, usec)
3399 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_PAD: attribute used for padding for 64-bit alignment
3400 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_ACK_SIGNAL: signal strength of the last ACK frame(u8, dBm)
3401 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_ACK_SIGNAL_AVG: avg signal strength of ACK frames (s8, dBm)
3402 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_MPDUS: total number of received packets (MPDUs)
3403 *	(u32, from this station)
3404 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_FCS_ERROR_COUNT: total number of packets (MPDUs) received
3405 *	with an FCS error (u32, from this station). This count may not include
3406 *	some packets with an FCS error due to TA corruption. Hence this counter
3407 *	might not be fully accurate.
3408 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_CONNECTED_TO_GATE: set to true if STA has a path to a
3409 *	mesh gate (u8, 0 or 1)
3410 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_DURATION: aggregate PPDU duration for all frames
3411 *	sent to the station (u64, usec)
3412 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_AIRTIME_WEIGHT: current airtime weight for station (u16)
3413 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_AIRTIME_LINK_METRIC: airtime link metric for mesh station
3414 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_ASSOC_AT_BOOTTIME: Timestamp (CLOCK_BOOTTIME, nanoseconds)
3415 *	of STA's association
3416 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_CONNECTED_TO_AS: set to true if STA has a path to a
3417 *	authentication server (u8, 0 or 1)
3418 * @__NL80211_STA_INFO_AFTER_LAST: internal
3419 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_MAX: highest possible station info attribute
3420 */
3421enum nl80211_sta_info {
3422	__NL80211_STA_INFO_INVALID,
3423	NL80211_STA_INFO_INACTIVE_TIME,
3424	NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_BYTES,
3425	NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_BYTES,
3426	NL80211_STA_INFO_LLID,
3427	NL80211_STA_INFO_PLID,
3428	NL80211_STA_INFO_PLINK_STATE,
3429	NL80211_STA_INFO_SIGNAL,
3430	NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_BITRATE,
3431	NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_PACKETS,
3432	NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_PACKETS,
3433	NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_RETRIES,
3434	NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_FAILED,
3435	NL80211_STA_INFO_SIGNAL_AVG,
3436	NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_BITRATE,
3437	NL80211_STA_INFO_BSS_PARAM,
3438	NL80211_STA_INFO_CONNECTED_TIME,
3439	NL80211_STA_INFO_STA_FLAGS,
3440	NL80211_STA_INFO_BEACON_LOSS,
3441	NL80211_STA_INFO_T_OFFSET,
3442	NL80211_STA_INFO_LOCAL_PM,
3443	NL80211_STA_INFO_PEER_PM,
3444	NL80211_STA_INFO_NONPEER_PM,
3445	NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_BYTES64,
3446	NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_BYTES64,
3447	NL80211_STA_INFO_CHAIN_SIGNAL,
3448	NL80211_STA_INFO_CHAIN_SIGNAL_AVG,
3449	NL80211_STA_INFO_EXPECTED_THROUGHPUT,
3450	NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_DROP_MISC,
3451	NL80211_STA_INFO_BEACON_RX,
3452	NL80211_STA_INFO_BEACON_SIGNAL_AVG,
3453	NL80211_STA_INFO_TID_STATS,
3454	NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_DURATION,
3455	NL80211_STA_INFO_PAD,
3456	NL80211_STA_INFO_NOISE,
3457	NL80211_STA_INFO_SNR,
3458	NL80211_STA_INFO_CNAHLOAD,
3459	NL80211_STA_INFO_UL_DELAY,
3460	NL80211_STA_INFO_ACK_SIGNAL,
3461	NL80211_STA_INFO_ACK_SIGNAL_AVG,
3462	NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_MPDUS,
3463	NL80211_STA_INFO_FCS_ERROR_COUNT,
3464	NL80211_STA_INFO_CONNECTED_TO_GATE,
3465	NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_DURATION,
3466	NL80211_STA_INFO_AIRTIME_WEIGHT,
3467	NL80211_STA_INFO_AIRTIME_LINK_METRIC,
3468	NL80211_STA_INFO_ASSOC_AT_BOOTTIME,
3469	NL80211_STA_INFO_CONNECTED_TO_AS,
3470
3471	/* keep last */
3472	__NL80211_STA_INFO_AFTER_LAST,
3473	NL80211_STA_INFO_MAX = __NL80211_STA_INFO_AFTER_LAST - 1
3474};
3475
3476/* we renamed this - stay compatible */
3477#define NL80211_STA_INFO_DATA_ACK_SIGNAL_AVG NL80211_STA_INFO_ACK_SIGNAL_AVG
3478
3479
3480/**
3481 * enum nl80211_tid_stats - per TID statistics attributes
3482 * @__NL80211_TID_STATS_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
3483 * @NL80211_TID_STATS_RX_MSDU: number of MSDUs received (u64)
3484 * @NL80211_TID_STATS_TX_MSDU: number of MSDUs transmitted (or
3485 *	attempted to transmit; u64)
3486 * @NL80211_TID_STATS_TX_MSDU_RETRIES: number of retries for
3487 *	transmitted MSDUs (not counting the first attempt; u64)
3488 * @NL80211_TID_STATS_TX_MSDU_FAILED: number of failed transmitted
3489 *	MSDUs (u64)
3490 * @NL80211_TID_STATS_PAD: attribute used for padding for 64-bit alignment
3491 * @NL80211_TID_STATS_TXQ_STATS: TXQ stats (nested attribute)
3492 * @NUM_NL80211_TID_STATS: number of attributes here
3493 * @NL80211_TID_STATS_MAX: highest numbered attribute here
3494 */
3495enum nl80211_tid_stats {
3496	__NL80211_TID_STATS_INVALID,
3497	NL80211_TID_STATS_RX_MSDU,
3498	NL80211_TID_STATS_TX_MSDU,
3499	NL80211_TID_STATS_TX_MSDU_RETRIES,
3500	NL80211_TID_STATS_TX_MSDU_FAILED,
3501	NL80211_TID_STATS_PAD,
3502	NL80211_TID_STATS_TXQ_STATS,
3503
3504	/* keep last */
3505	NUM_NL80211_TID_STATS,
3506	NL80211_TID_STATS_MAX = NUM_NL80211_TID_STATS - 1
3507};
3508
3509/**
3510 * enum nl80211_txq_stats - per TXQ statistics attributes
3511 * @__NL80211_TXQ_STATS_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
3512 * @NUM_NL80211_TXQ_STATS: number of attributes here
3513 * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_BACKLOG_BYTES: number of bytes currently backlogged
3514 * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_BACKLOG_PACKETS: number of packets currently
3515 *      backlogged
3516 * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_FLOWS: total number of new flows seen
3517 * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_DROPS: total number of packet drops
3518 * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_ECN_MARKS: total number of packet ECN marks
3519 * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_OVERLIMIT: number of drops due to queue space overflow
3520 * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_OVERMEMORY: number of drops due to memory limit overflow
3521 *      (only for per-phy stats)
3522 * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_COLLISIONS: number of hash collisions
3523 * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_TX_BYTES: total number of bytes dequeued from TXQ
3524 * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_TX_PACKETS: total number of packets dequeued from TXQ
3525 * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_MAX_FLOWS: number of flow buckets for PHY
3526 * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_MAX: highest numbered attribute here
3527 */
3528enum nl80211_txq_stats {
3529	__NL80211_TXQ_STATS_INVALID,
3530	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_BACKLOG_BYTES,
3531	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_BACKLOG_PACKETS,
3532	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_FLOWS,
3533	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_DROPS,
3534	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_ECN_MARKS,
3535	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_OVERLIMIT,
3536	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_OVERMEMORY,
3537	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_COLLISIONS,
3538	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_TX_BYTES,
3539	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_TX_PACKETS,
3540	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_MAX_FLOWS,
3541
3542	/* keep last */
3543	NUM_NL80211_TXQ_STATS,
3544	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_MAX = NUM_NL80211_TXQ_STATS - 1
3545};
3546
3547/**
3548 * enum nl80211_mpath_flags - nl80211 mesh path flags
3549 *
3550 * @NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_ACTIVE: the mesh path is active
3551 * @NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_RESOLVING: the mesh path discovery process is running
3552 * @NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_SN_VALID: the mesh path contains a valid SN
3553 * @NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_FIXED: the mesh path has been manually set
3554 * @NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_RESOLVED: the mesh path discovery process succeeded
3555 */
3556enum nl80211_mpath_flags {
3557	NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_ACTIVE =	1<<0,
3558	NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_RESOLVING =	1<<1,
3559	NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_SN_VALID =	1<<2,
3560	NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_FIXED =	1<<3,
3561	NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_RESOLVED =	1<<4,
3562};
3563
3564/**
3565 * enum nl80211_mpath_info - mesh path information
3566 *
3567 * These attribute types are used with %NL80211_ATTR_MPATH_INFO when getting
3568 * information about a mesh path.
3569 *
3570 * @__NL80211_MPATH_INFO_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
3571 * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_FRAME_QLEN: number of queued frames for this destination
3572 * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_SN: destination sequence number
3573 * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_METRIC: metric (cost) of this mesh path
3574 * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_EXPTIME: expiration time for the path, in msec from now
3575 * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_FLAGS: mesh path flags, enumerated in
3576 * 	&enum nl80211_mpath_flags;
3577 * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_TIMEOUT: total path discovery timeout, in msec
3578 * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_RETRIES: mesh path discovery retries
3579 * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_HOP_COUNT: hop count to destination
3580 * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_PATH_CHANGE: total number of path changes to destination
3581 * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_MAX: highest mesh path information attribute number
3582 *	currently defined
3583 * @__NL80211_MPATH_INFO_AFTER_LAST: internal use
3584 */
3585enum nl80211_mpath_info {
3586	__NL80211_MPATH_INFO_INVALID,
3587	NL80211_MPATH_INFO_FRAME_QLEN,
3588	NL80211_MPATH_INFO_SN,
3589	NL80211_MPATH_INFO_METRIC,
3590	NL80211_MPATH_INFO_EXPTIME,
3591	NL80211_MPATH_INFO_FLAGS,
3592	NL80211_MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_TIMEOUT,
3593	NL80211_MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_RETRIES,
3594	NL80211_MPATH_INFO_HOP_COUNT,
3595	NL80211_MPATH_INFO_PATH_CHANGE,
3596
3597	/* keep last */
3598	__NL80211_MPATH_INFO_AFTER_LAST,
3599	NL80211_MPATH_INFO_MAX = __NL80211_MPATH_INFO_AFTER_LAST - 1
3600};
3601
3602/**
3603 * enum nl80211_band_iftype_attr - Interface type data attributes
3604 *
3605 * @__NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
3606 * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_IFTYPES: nested attribute containing a flag attribute
3607 *     for each interface type that supports the band data
3608 * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_CAP_MAC: HE MAC capabilities as in HE
3609 *     capabilities IE
3610 * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_CAP_PHY: HE PHY capabilities as in HE
3611 *     capabilities IE
3612 * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_CAP_MCS_SET: HE supported NSS/MCS as in HE
3613 *     capabilities IE
3614 * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_CAP_PPE: HE PPE thresholds information as
3615 *     defined in HE capabilities IE
3616 * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_MAX: highest band HE capability attribute currently
3617 *     defined
3618 * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_6GHZ_CAPA: HE 6GHz band capabilities (__le16),
3619 *	given for all 6 GHz band channels
3620 * @__NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use
3621 */
3622enum nl80211_band_iftype_attr {
3623	__NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_INVALID,
3624
3625	NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_IFTYPES,
3626	NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_CAP_MAC,
3627	NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_CAP_PHY,
3628	NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_CAP_MCS_SET,
3629	NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_CAP_PPE,
3630	NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_6GHZ_CAPA,
3631
3632	/* keep last */
3633	__NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
3634	NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
3635};
3636
3637/**
3638 * enum nl80211_band_attr - band attributes
3639 * @__NL80211_BAND_ATTR_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
3640 * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_FREQS: supported frequencies in this band,
3641 *	an array of nested frequency attributes
3642 * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_RATES: supported bitrates in this band,
3643 *	an array of nested bitrate attributes
3644 * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_MCS_SET: 16-byte attribute containing the MCS set as
3645 *	defined in 802.11n
3646 * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_CAPA: HT capabilities, as in the HT information IE
3647 * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_AMPDU_FACTOR: A-MPDU factor, as in 11n
3648 * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_AMPDU_DENSITY: A-MPDU density, as in 11n
3649 * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_VHT_MCS_SET: 32-byte attribute containing the MCS set as
3650 *	defined in 802.11ac
3651 * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_VHT_CAPA: VHT capabilities, as in the HT information IE
3652 * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_IFTYPE_DATA: nested array attribute, with each entry using
3653 *	attributes from &enum nl80211_band_iftype_attr
3654 * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_EDMG_CHANNELS: bitmap that indicates the 2.16 GHz
3655 *	channel(s) that are allowed to be used for EDMG transmissions.
3656 *	Defined by IEEE P802.11ay/D4.0 section 9.4.2.251.
3657 * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_EDMG_BW_CONFIG: Channel BW Configuration subfield encodes
3658 *	the allowed channel bandwidth configurations.
3659 *	Defined by IEEE P802.11ay/D4.0 section 9.4.2.251, Table 13.
3660 * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_MAX: highest band attribute currently defined
3661 * @__NL80211_BAND_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use
3662 */
3663enum nl80211_band_attr {
3664	__NL80211_BAND_ATTR_INVALID,
3665	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_FREQS,
3666	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_RATES,
3667
3668	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_MCS_SET,
3669	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_CAPA,
3670	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_AMPDU_FACTOR,
3671	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_AMPDU_DENSITY,
3672
3673	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_VHT_MCS_SET,
3674	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_VHT_CAPA,
3675	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_IFTYPE_DATA,
3676
3677	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_EDMG_CHANNELS,
3678	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_EDMG_BW_CONFIG,
3679
3680	/* keep last */
3681	__NL80211_BAND_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
3682	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_BAND_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
3683};
3684
3685#define NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_CAPA NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_CAPA
3686
3687/**
3688 * enum nl80211_wmm_rule - regulatory wmm rule
3689 *
3690 * @__NL80211_WMMR_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
3691 * @NL80211_WMMR_CW_MIN: Minimum contention window slot.
3692 * @NL80211_WMMR_CW_MAX: Maximum contention window slot.
3693 * @NL80211_WMMR_AIFSN: Arbitration Inter Frame Space.
3694 * @NL80211_WMMR_TXOP: Maximum allowed tx operation time.
3695 * @nl80211_WMMR_MAX: highest possible wmm rule.
3696 * @__NL80211_WMMR_LAST: Internal use.
3697 */
3698enum nl80211_wmm_rule {
3699	__NL80211_WMMR_INVALID,
3700	NL80211_WMMR_CW_MIN,
3701	NL80211_WMMR_CW_MAX,
3702	NL80211_WMMR_AIFSN,
3703	NL80211_WMMR_TXOP,
3704
3705	/* keep last */
3706	__NL80211_WMMR_LAST,
3707	NL80211_WMMR_MAX = __NL80211_WMMR_LAST - 1
3708};
3709
3710/**
3711 * enum nl80211_frequency_attr - frequency attributes
3712 * @__NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
3713 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_FREQ: Frequency in MHz
3714 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DISABLED: Channel is disabled in current
3715 *	regulatory domain.
3716 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IR: no mechanisms that initiate radiation
3717 * 	are permitted on this channel, this includes sending probe
3718 * 	requests, or modes of operation that require beaconing.
3719 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_RADAR: Radar detection is mandatory
3720 *	on this channel in current regulatory domain.
3721 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_MAX_TX_POWER: Maximum transmission power in mBm
3722 *	(100 * dBm).
3723 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DFS_STATE: current state for DFS
3724 *	(enum nl80211_dfs_state)
3725 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DFS_TIME: time in miliseconds for how long
3726 *	this channel is in this DFS state.
3727 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_HT40_MINUS: HT40- isn't possible with this
3728 *	channel as the control channel
3729 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_HT40_PLUS: HT40+ isn't possible with this
3730 *	channel as the control channel
3731 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_80MHZ: any 80 MHz channel using this channel
3732 *	as the primary or any of the secondary channels isn't possible,
3733 *	this includes 80+80 channels
3734 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_160MHZ: any 160 MHz (but not 80+80) channel
3735 *	using this channel as the primary or any of the secondary channels
3736 *	isn't possible
3737 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DFS_CAC_TIME: DFS CAC time in milliseconds.
3738 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_INDOOR_ONLY: Only indoor use is permitted on this
3739 *	channel. A channel that has the INDOOR_ONLY attribute can only be
3740 *	used when there is a clear assessment that the device is operating in
3741 *	an indoor surroundings, i.e., it is connected to AC power (and not
3742 *	through portable DC inverters) or is under the control of a master
3743 *	that is acting as an AP and is connected to AC power.
3744 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_IR_CONCURRENT: IR operation is allowed on this
3745 *	channel if it's connected concurrently to a BSS on the same channel on
3746 *	the 2 GHz band or to a channel in the same UNII band (on the 5 GHz
3747 *	band), and IEEE80211_CHAN_RADAR is not set. Instantiating a GO or TDLS
3748 *	off-channel on a channel that has the IR_CONCURRENT attribute set can be
3749 *	done when there is a clear assessment that the device is operating under
3750 *	the guidance of an authorized master, i.e., setting up a GO or TDLS
3751 *	off-channel while the device is also connected to an AP with DFS and
3752 *	radar detection on the UNII band (it is up to user-space, i.e.,
3753 *	wpa_supplicant to perform the required verifications). Using this
3754 *	attribute for IR is disallowed for master interfaces (IBSS, AP).
3755 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_20MHZ: 20 MHz operation is not allowed
3756 *	on this channel in current regulatory domain.
3757 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_10MHZ: 10 MHz operation is not allowed
3758 *	on this channel in current regulatory domain.
3759 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_WMM: this channel has wmm limitations.
3760 *	This is a nested attribute that contains the wmm limitation per AC.
3761 *	(see &enum nl80211_wmm_rule)
3762 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_HE: HE operation is not allowed on this channel
3763 *	in current regulatory domain.
3764 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_OFFSET: frequency offset in KHz
3765 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_1MHZ: 1 MHz operation is allowed
3766 *	on this channel in current regulatory domain.
3767 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_2MHZ: 2 MHz operation is allowed
3768 *	on this channel in current regulatory domain.
3769 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_4MHZ: 4 MHz operation is allowed
3770 *	on this channel in current regulatory domain.
3771 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_8MHZ: 8 MHz operation is allowed
3772 *	on this channel in current regulatory domain.
3773 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_16MHZ: 16 MHz operation is allowed
3774 *	on this channel in current regulatory domain.
3775 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_MAX: highest frequency attribute number
3776 *	currently defined
3777 * @__NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use
3778 *
3779 * See https://apps.fcc.gov/eas/comments/GetPublishedDocument.html?id=327&tn=528122
3780 * for more information on the FCC description of the relaxations allowed
3781 * by NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_INDOOR_ONLY and
3782 * NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_IR_CONCURRENT.
3783 */
3784enum nl80211_frequency_attr {
3785	__NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_INVALID,
3786	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_FREQ,
3787	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DISABLED,
3788	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IR,
3789	__NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IBSS,
3790	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_RADAR,
3791	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_MAX_TX_POWER,
3792	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DFS_STATE,
3793	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DFS_TIME,
3794	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_HT40_MINUS,
3795	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_HT40_PLUS,
3796	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_80MHZ,
3797	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_160MHZ,
3798	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DFS_CAC_TIME,
3799	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_INDOOR_ONLY,
3800	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_IR_CONCURRENT,
3801	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_20MHZ,
3802	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_10MHZ,
3803	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_WMM,
3804	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_HE,
3805	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_OFFSET,
3806	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_1MHZ,
3807	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_2MHZ,
3808	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_4MHZ,
3809	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_8MHZ,
3810	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_16MHZ,
3811
3812	/* keep last */
3813	__NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
3814	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
3815};
3816
3817#define NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_MAX_TX_POWER NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_MAX_TX_POWER
3818#define NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_PASSIVE_SCAN	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IR
3819#define NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IBSS		NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IR
3820#define NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IR		NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IR
3821#define NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_GO_CONCURRENT \
3822					NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_IR_CONCURRENT
3823
3824/**
3825 * enum nl80211_bitrate_attr - bitrate attributes
3826 * @__NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
3827 * @NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_RATE: Bitrate in units of 100 kbps
3828 * @NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_2GHZ_SHORTPREAMBLE: Short preamble supported
3829 *	in 2.4 GHz band.
3830 * @NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_MAX: highest bitrate attribute number
3831 *	currently defined
3832 * @__NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use
3833 */
3834enum nl80211_bitrate_attr {
3835	__NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_INVALID,
3836	NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_RATE,
3837	NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_2GHZ_SHORTPREAMBLE,
3838
3839	/* keep last */
3840	__NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
3841	NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
3842};
3843
3844/**
3845 * enum nl80211_initiator - Indicates the initiator of a reg domain request
3846 * @NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_CORE: Core queried CRDA for a dynamic world
3847 * 	regulatory domain.
3848 * @NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_USER: User asked the wireless core to set the
3849 * 	regulatory domain.
3850 * @NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_DRIVER: a wireless drivers has hinted to the
3851 * 	wireless core it thinks its knows the regulatory domain we should be in.
3852 * @NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_COUNTRY_IE: the wireless core has received an
3853 * 	802.11 country information element with regulatory information it
3854 * 	thinks we should consider. cfg80211 only processes the country
3855 *	code from the IE, and relies on the regulatory domain information
3856 *	structure passed by userspace (CRDA) from our wireless-regdb.
3857 *	If a channel is enabled but the country code indicates it should
3858 *	be disabled we disable the channel and re-enable it upon disassociation.
3859 */
3860enum nl80211_reg_initiator {
3861	NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_CORE,
3862	NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_USER,
3863	NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_DRIVER,
3864	NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_COUNTRY_IE,
3865};
3866
3867/**
3868 * enum nl80211_reg_type - specifies the type of regulatory domain
3869 * @NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_COUNTRY: the regulatory domain set is one that pertains
3870 *	to a specific country. When this is set you can count on the
3871 *	ISO / IEC 3166 alpha2 country code being valid.
3872 * @NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_WORLD: the regulatory set domain is the world regulatory
3873 * 	domain.
3874 * @NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_CUSTOM_WORLD: the regulatory domain set is a custom
3875 * 	driver specific world regulatory domain. These do not apply system-wide
3876 * 	and are only applicable to the individual devices which have requested
3877 * 	them to be applied.
3878 * @NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_INTERSECTION: the regulatory domain set is the product
3879 *	of an intersection between two regulatory domains -- the previously
3880 *	set regulatory domain on the system and the last accepted regulatory
3881 *	domain request to be processed.
3882 */
3883enum nl80211_reg_type {
3884	NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_COUNTRY,
3885	NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_WORLD,
3886	NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_CUSTOM_WORLD,
3887	NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_INTERSECTION,
3888};
3889
3890/**
3891 * enum nl80211_reg_rule_attr - regulatory rule attributes
3892 * @__NL80211_REG_RULE_ATTR_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
3893 * @NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULE_FLAGS: a set of flags which specify additional
3894 * 	considerations for a given frequency range. These are the
3895 * 	&enum nl80211_reg_rule_flags.
3896 * @NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_RANGE_START: starting frequencry for the regulatory
3897 * 	rule in KHz. This is not a center of frequency but an actual regulatory
3898 * 	band edge.
3899 * @NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_RANGE_END: ending frequency for the regulatory rule
3900 * 	in KHz. This is not a center a frequency but an actual regulatory
3901 * 	band edge.
3902 * @NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_RANGE_MAX_BW: maximum allowed bandwidth for this
3903 *	frequency range, in KHz.
3904 * @NL80211_ATTR_POWER_RULE_MAX_ANT_GAIN: the maximum allowed antenna gain
3905 * 	for a given frequency range. The value is in mBi (100 * dBi).
3906 * 	If you don't have one then don't send this.
3907 * @NL80211_ATTR_POWER_RULE_MAX_EIRP: the maximum allowed EIRP for
3908 * 	a given frequency range. The value is in mBm (100 * dBm).
3909 * @NL80211_ATTR_DFS_CAC_TIME: DFS CAC time in milliseconds.
3910 *	If not present or 0 default CAC time will be used.
3911 * @NL80211_REG_RULE_ATTR_MAX: highest regulatory rule attribute number
3912 *	currently defined
3913 * @__NL80211_REG_RULE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use
3914 */
3915enum nl80211_reg_rule_attr {
3916	__NL80211_REG_RULE_ATTR_INVALID,
3917	NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULE_FLAGS,
3918
3919	NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_RANGE_START,
3920	NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_RANGE_END,
3921	NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_RANGE_MAX_BW,
3922
3923	NL80211_ATTR_POWER_RULE_MAX_ANT_GAIN,
3924	NL80211_ATTR_POWER_RULE_MAX_EIRP,
3925
3926	NL80211_ATTR_DFS_CAC_TIME,
3927
3928	/* keep last */
3929	__NL80211_REG_RULE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
3930	NL80211_REG_RULE_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_REG_RULE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
3931};
3932
3933/**
3934 * enum nl80211_sched_scan_match_attr - scheduled scan match attributes
3935 * @__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
3936 * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_SSID: SSID to be used for matching,
3937 *	only report BSS with matching SSID.
3938 *	(This cannot be used together with BSSID.)
3939 * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_RSSI: RSSI threshold (in dBm) for reporting a
3940 *	BSS in scan results. Filtering is turned off if not specified. Note that
3941 *	if this attribute is in a match set of its own, then it is treated as
3942 *	the default value for all matchsets with an SSID, rather than being a
3943 *	matchset of its own without an RSSI filter. This is due to problems with
3944 *	how this API was implemented in the past. Also, due to the same problem,
3945 *	the only way to create a matchset with only an RSSI filter (with this
3946 *	attribute) is if there's only a single matchset with the RSSI attribute.
3947 * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_RELATIVE_RSSI: Flag indicating whether
3948 *	%NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_RSSI to be used as absolute RSSI or
3949 *	relative to current bss's RSSI.
3950 * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_RSSI_ADJUST: When present the RSSI level for
3951 *	BSS-es in the specified band is to be adjusted before doing
3952 *	RSSI-based BSS selection. The attribute value is a packed structure
3953 *	value as specified by &struct nl80211_bss_select_rssi_adjust.
3954 * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_BSSID: BSSID to be used for matching
3955 *	(this cannot be used together with SSID).
3956 * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_PER_BAND_RSSI: Nested attribute that carries the
3957 *	band specific minimum rssi thresholds for the bands defined in
3958 *	enum nl80211_band. The minimum rssi threshold value(s32) specific to a
3959 *	band shall be encapsulated in attribute with type value equals to one
3960 *	of the NL80211_BAND_* defined in enum nl80211_band. For example, the
3961 *	minimum rssi threshold value for 2.4GHZ band shall be encapsulated
3962 *	within an attribute of type NL80211_BAND_2GHZ. And one or more of such
3963 *	attributes will be nested within this attribute.
3964 * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_MAX: highest scheduled scan filter
3965 *	attribute number currently defined
3966 * @__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use
3967 */
3968enum nl80211_sched_scan_match_attr {
3969	__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_INVALID,
3970
3971	NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_SSID,
3972	NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_RSSI,
3973	NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_RELATIVE_RSSI,
3974	NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_RSSI_ADJUST,
3975	NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_BSSID,
3976	NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_PER_BAND_RSSI,
3977
3978	/* keep last */
3979	__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
3980	NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_MAX =
3981		__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
3982};
3983
3984/* only for backward compatibility */
3985#define NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_SSID NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_SSID
3986
3987/**
3988 * enum nl80211_reg_rule_flags - regulatory rule flags
3989 *
3990 * @NL80211_RRF_NO_OFDM: OFDM modulation not allowed
3991 * @NL80211_RRF_NO_CCK: CCK modulation not allowed
3992 * @NL80211_RRF_NO_INDOOR: indoor operation not allowed
3993 * @NL80211_RRF_NO_OUTDOOR: outdoor operation not allowed
3994 * @NL80211_RRF_DFS: DFS support is required to be used
3995 * @NL80211_RRF_PTP_ONLY: this is only for Point To Point links
3996 * @NL80211_RRF_PTMP_ONLY: this is only for Point To Multi Point links
3997 * @NL80211_RRF_NO_IR: no mechanisms that initiate radiation are allowed,
3998 * 	this includes probe requests or modes of operation that require
3999 * 	beaconing.
4000 * @NL80211_RRF_AUTO_BW: maximum available bandwidth should be calculated
4001 *	base on contiguous rules and wider channels will be allowed to cross
4002 *	multiple contiguous/overlapping frequency ranges.
4003 * @NL80211_RRF_IR_CONCURRENT: See %NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_IR_CONCURRENT
4004 * @NL80211_RRF_NO_HT40MINUS: channels can't be used in HT40- operation
4005 * @NL80211_RRF_NO_HT40PLUS: channels can't be used in HT40+ operation
4006 * @NL80211_RRF_NO_80MHZ: 80MHz operation not allowed
4007 * @NL80211_RRF_NO_160MHZ: 160MHz operation not allowed
4008 * @NL80211_RRF_NO_HE: HE operation not allowed
4009 */
4010enum nl80211_reg_rule_flags {
4011	NL80211_RRF_NO_OFDM		= 1<<0,
4012	NL80211_RRF_NO_CCK		= 1<<1,
4013	NL80211_RRF_NO_INDOOR		= 1<<2,
4014	NL80211_RRF_NO_OUTDOOR		= 1<<3,
4015	NL80211_RRF_DFS			= 1<<4,
4016	NL80211_RRF_PTP_ONLY		= 1<<5,
4017	NL80211_RRF_PTMP_ONLY		= 1<<6,
4018	NL80211_RRF_NO_IR		= 1<<7,
4019	__NL80211_RRF_NO_IBSS		= 1<<8,
4020	NL80211_RRF_AUTO_BW		= 1<<11,
4021	NL80211_RRF_IR_CONCURRENT	= 1<<12,
4022	NL80211_RRF_NO_HT40MINUS	= 1<<13,
4023	NL80211_RRF_NO_HT40PLUS		= 1<<14,
4024	NL80211_RRF_NO_80MHZ		= 1<<15,
4025	NL80211_RRF_NO_160MHZ		= 1<<16,
4026	NL80211_RRF_NO_HE		= 1<<17,
4027};
4028
4029#define NL80211_RRF_PASSIVE_SCAN	NL80211_RRF_NO_IR
4030#define NL80211_RRF_NO_IBSS		NL80211_RRF_NO_IR
4031#define NL80211_RRF_NO_IR		NL80211_RRF_NO_IR
4032#define NL80211_RRF_NO_HT40		(NL80211_RRF_NO_HT40MINUS |\
4033					 NL80211_RRF_NO_HT40PLUS)
4034#define NL80211_RRF_GO_CONCURRENT	NL80211_RRF_IR_CONCURRENT
4035
4036/* For backport compatibility with older userspace */
4037#define NL80211_RRF_NO_IR_ALL		(NL80211_RRF_NO_IR | __NL80211_RRF_NO_IBSS)
4038
4039/**
4040 * enum nl80211_dfs_regions - regulatory DFS regions
4041 *
4042 * @NL80211_DFS_UNSET: Country has no DFS master region specified
4043 * @NL80211_DFS_FCC: Country follows DFS master rules from FCC
4044 * @NL80211_DFS_ETSI: Country follows DFS master rules from ETSI
4045 * @NL80211_DFS_JP: Country follows DFS master rules from JP/MKK/Telec
4046 */
4047enum nl80211_dfs_regions {
4048	NL80211_DFS_UNSET	= 0,
4049	NL80211_DFS_FCC		= 1,
4050	NL80211_DFS_ETSI	= 2,
4051	NL80211_DFS_JP		= 3,
4052};
4053
4054/**
4055 * enum nl80211_user_reg_hint_type - type of user regulatory hint
4056 *
4057 * @NL80211_USER_REG_HINT_USER: a user sent the hint. This is always
4058 *	assumed if the attribute is not set.
4059 * @NL80211_USER_REG_HINT_CELL_BASE: the hint comes from a cellular
4060 *	base station. Device drivers that have been tested to work
4061 *	properly to support this type of hint can enable these hints
4062 *	by setting the NL80211_FEATURE_CELL_BASE_REG_HINTS feature
4063 *	capability on the struct wiphy. The wireless core will
4064 *	ignore all cell base station hints until at least one device
4065 *	present has been registered with the wireless core that
4066 *	has listed NL80211_FEATURE_CELL_BASE_REG_HINTS as a
4067 *	supported feature.
4068 * @NL80211_USER_REG_HINT_INDOOR: a user sent an hint indicating that the
4069 *	platform is operating in an indoor environment.
4070 */
4071enum nl80211_user_reg_hint_type {
4072	NL80211_USER_REG_HINT_USER	= 0,
4073	NL80211_USER_REG_HINT_CELL_BASE = 1,
4074	NL80211_USER_REG_HINT_INDOOR    = 2,
4075};
4076
4077/**
4078 * enum nl80211_survey_info - survey information
4079 *
4080 * These attribute types are used with %NL80211_ATTR_SURVEY_INFO
4081 * when getting information about a survey.
4082 *
4083 * @__NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
4084 * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_FREQUENCY: center frequency of channel
4085 * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_NOISE: noise level of channel (u8, dBm)
4086 * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_IN_USE: channel is currently being used
4087 * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME: amount of time (in ms) that the radio
4088 *	was turned on (on channel or globally)
4089 * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BUSY: amount of the time the primary
4090 *	channel was sensed busy (either due to activity or energy detect)
4091 * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_EXT_BUSY: amount of time the extension
4092 *	channel was sensed busy
4093 * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_RX: amount of time the radio spent
4094 *	receiving data (on channel or globally)
4095 * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_TX: amount of time the radio spent
4096 *	transmitting data (on channel or globally)
4097 * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_SCAN: time the radio spent for scan
4098 *	(on this channel or globally)
4099 * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_PAD: attribute used for padding for 64-bit alignment
4100 * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BSS_RX: amount of time the radio spent
4101 *	receiving frames destined to the local BSS
4102 * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_MAX: highest survey info attribute number
4103 *	currently defined
4104 * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_FREQUENCY_OFFSET: center frequency offset in KHz
4105 * @__NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_AFTER_LAST: internal use
4106 */
4107enum nl80211_survey_info {
4108	__NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_INVALID,
4109	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_FREQUENCY,
4110	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_NOISE,
4111	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_IN_USE,
4112	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME,
4113	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BUSY,
4114	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_EXT_BUSY,
4115	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_RX,
4116	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_TX,
4117	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_SCAN,
4118	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_PAD,
4119	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BSS_RX,
4120	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_FREQUENCY_OFFSET,
4121
4122	/* keep last */
4123	__NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_AFTER_LAST,
4124	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_MAX = __NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_AFTER_LAST - 1
4125};
4126
4127/* keep old names for compatibility */
4128#define NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_CHANNEL_TIME		NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME
4129#define NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_CHANNEL_TIME_BUSY		NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BUSY
4130#define NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_CHANNEL_TIME_EXT_BUSY	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_EXT_BUSY
4131#define NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_CHANNEL_TIME_RX		NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_RX
4132#define NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_CHANNEL_TIME_TX		NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_TX
4133
4134/**
4135 * enum nl80211_mntr_flags - monitor configuration flags
4136 *
4137 * Monitor configuration flags.
4138 *
4139 * @__NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_INVALID: reserved
4140 *
4141 * @NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_FCSFAIL: pass frames with bad FCS
4142 * @NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_PLCPFAIL: pass frames with bad PLCP
4143 * @NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_CONTROL: pass control frames
4144 * @NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_OTHER_BSS: disable BSSID filtering
4145 * @NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_COOK_FRAMES: report frames after processing.
4146 *	overrides all other flags.
4147 * @NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_ACTIVE: use the configured MAC address
4148 *	and ACK incoming unicast packets.
4149 *
4150 * @__NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_AFTER_LAST: internal use
4151 * @NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_MAX: highest possible monitor flag
4152 */
4153enum nl80211_mntr_flags {
4154	__NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_INVALID,
4155	NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_FCSFAIL,
4156	NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_PLCPFAIL,
4157	NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_CONTROL,
4158	NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_OTHER_BSS,
4159	NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_COOK_FRAMES,
4160	NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_ACTIVE,
4161
4162	/* keep last */
4163	__NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_AFTER_LAST,
4164	NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_MAX = __NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_AFTER_LAST - 1
4165};
4166
4167/**
4168 * enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode - mesh power save modes
4169 *
4170 * @NL80211_MESH_POWER_UNKNOWN: The mesh power mode of the mesh STA is
4171 *	not known or has not been set yet.
4172 * @NL80211_MESH_POWER_ACTIVE: Active mesh power mode. The mesh STA is
4173 *	in Awake state all the time.
4174 * @NL80211_MESH_POWER_LIGHT_SLEEP: Light sleep mode. The mesh STA will
4175 *	alternate between Active and Doze states, but will wake up for
4176 *	neighbor's beacons.
4177 * @NL80211_MESH_POWER_DEEP_SLEEP: Deep sleep mode. The mesh STA will
4178 *	alternate between Active and Doze states, but may not wake up
4179 *	for neighbor's beacons.
4180 *
4181 * @__NL80211_MESH_POWER_AFTER_LAST - internal use
4182 * @NL80211_MESH_POWER_MAX - highest possible power save level
4183 */
4184
4185enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode {
4186	NL80211_MESH_POWER_UNKNOWN,
4187	NL80211_MESH_POWER_ACTIVE,
4188	NL80211_MESH_POWER_LIGHT_SLEEP,
4189	NL80211_MESH_POWER_DEEP_SLEEP,
4190
4191	__NL80211_MESH_POWER_AFTER_LAST,
4192	NL80211_MESH_POWER_MAX = __NL80211_MESH_POWER_AFTER_LAST - 1
4193};
4194
4195/**
4196 * enum nl80211_meshconf_params - mesh configuration parameters
4197 *
4198 * Mesh configuration parameters. These can be changed while the mesh is
4199 * active.
4200 *
4201 * @__NL80211_MESHCONF_INVALID: internal use
4202 *
4203 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_RETRY_TIMEOUT: specifies the initial retry timeout in
4204 *	millisecond units, used by the Peer Link Open message
4205 *
4206 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_CONFIRM_TIMEOUT: specifies the initial confirm timeout, in
4207 *	millisecond units, used by the peer link management to close a peer link
4208 *
4209 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HOLDING_TIMEOUT: specifies the holding timeout, in
4210 *	millisecond units
4211 *
4212 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_MAX_PEER_LINKS: maximum number of peer links allowed
4213 *	on this mesh interface
4214 *
4215 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_MAX_RETRIES: specifies the maximum number of peer link
4216 *	open retries that can be sent to establish a new peer link instance in a
4217 *	mesh
4218 *
4219 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_TTL: specifies the value of TTL field set at a source mesh
4220 *	point.
4221 *
4222 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_AUTO_OPEN_PLINKS: whether we should automatically open
4223 *	peer links when we detect compatible mesh peers. Disabled if
4224 *	@NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_MPM or @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AMPE are
4225 *	set.
4226 *
4227 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_MAX_PREQ_RETRIES: the number of action frames
4228 *	containing a PREQ that an MP can send to a particular destination (path
4229 *	target)
4230 *
4231 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_PATH_REFRESH_TIME: how frequently to refresh mesh paths
4232 *	(in milliseconds)
4233 *
4234 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_MIN_DISCOVERY_TIMEOUT: minimum length of time to wait
4235 *	until giving up on a path discovery (in milliseconds)
4236 *
4237 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_ACTIVE_PATH_TIMEOUT: The time (in TUs) for which mesh
4238 *	points receiving a PREQ shall consider the forwarding information from
4239 *	the root to be valid. (TU = time unit)
4240 *
4241 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_PREQ_MIN_INTERVAL: The minimum interval of time (in
4242 *	TUs) during which an MP can send only one action frame containing a PREQ
4243 *	reference element
4244 *
4245 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_NET_DIAM_TRVS_TIME: The interval of time (in TUs)
4246 *	that it takes for an HWMP information element to propagate across the
4247 *	mesh
4248 *
4249 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_ROOTMODE: whether root mode is enabled or not
4250 *
4251 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_ELEMENT_TTL: specifies the value of TTL field set at a
4252 *	source mesh point for path selection elements.
4253 *
4254 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_RANN_INTERVAL:  The interval of time (in TUs) between
4255 *	root announcements are transmitted.
4256 *
4257 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_GATE_ANNOUNCEMENTS: Advertise that this mesh station has
4258 *	access to a broader network beyond the MBSS.  This is done via Root
4259 *	Announcement frames.
4260 *
4261 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_PERR_MIN_INTERVAL: The minimum interval of time (in
4262 *	TUs) during which a mesh STA can send only one Action frame containing a
4263 *	PERR element.
4264 *
4265 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_FORWARDING: set Mesh STA as forwarding or non-forwarding
4266 *	or forwarding entity (default is TRUE - forwarding entity)
4267 *
4268 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_RSSI_THRESHOLD: RSSI threshold in dBm. This specifies the
4269 *	threshold for average signal strength of candidate station to establish
4270 *	a peer link.
4271 *
4272 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_SYNC_OFFSET_MAX_NEIGHBOR: maximum number of neighbors
4273 *	to synchronize to for 11s default synchronization method
4274 *	(see 11C.12.2.2)
4275 *
4276 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HT_OPMODE: set mesh HT protection mode.
4277 *
4278 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_ATTR_MAX: highest possible mesh configuration attribute
4279 *
4280 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_PATH_TO_ROOT_TIMEOUT: The time (in TUs) for
4281 *	which mesh STAs receiving a proactive PREQ shall consider the forwarding
4282 *	information to the root mesh STA to be valid.
4283 *
4284 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_ROOT_INTERVAL: The interval of time (in TUs) between
4285 *	proactive PREQs are transmitted.
4286 *
4287 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_CONFIRMATION_INTERVAL: The minimum interval of time
4288 *	(in TUs) during which a mesh STA can send only one Action frame
4289 *	containing a PREQ element for root path confirmation.
4290 *
4291 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_POWER_MODE: Default mesh power mode for new peer links.
4292 *	type &enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode (u32)
4293 *
4294 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_AWAKE_WINDOW: awake window duration (in TUs)
4295 *
4296 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_PLINK_TIMEOUT: If no tx activity is seen from a STA we've
4297 *	established peering with for longer than this time (in seconds), then
4298 *	remove it from the STA's list of peers. You may set this to 0 to disable
4299 *	the removal of the STA. Default is 30 minutes.
4300 *
4301 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_CONNECTED_TO_GATE: If set to true then this mesh STA
4302 *	will advertise that it is connected to a gate in the mesh formation
4303 *	field.  If left unset then the mesh formation field will only
4304 *	advertise such if there is an active root mesh path.
4305 *
4306 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_NOLEARN: Try to avoid multi-hop path discovery (e.g.
4307 *      PREQ/PREP for HWMP) if the destination is a direct neighbor. Note that
4308 *      this might not be the optimal decision as a multi-hop route might be
4309 *      better. So if using this setting you will likely also want to disable
4310 *      dot11MeshForwarding and use another mesh routing protocol on top.
4311 *
4312 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_CONNECTED_TO_AS: If set to true then this mesh STA
4313 *	will advertise that it is connected to a authentication server
4314 *	in the mesh formation field.
4315 *
4316 * @__NL80211_MESHCONF_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use
4317 */
4318enum nl80211_meshconf_params {
4319	__NL80211_MESHCONF_INVALID,
4320	NL80211_MESHCONF_RETRY_TIMEOUT,
4321	NL80211_MESHCONF_CONFIRM_TIMEOUT,
4322	NL80211_MESHCONF_HOLDING_TIMEOUT,
4323	NL80211_MESHCONF_MAX_PEER_LINKS,
4324	NL80211_MESHCONF_MAX_RETRIES,
4325	NL80211_MESHCONF_TTL,
4326	NL80211_MESHCONF_AUTO_OPEN_PLINKS,
4327	NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_MAX_PREQ_RETRIES,
4328	NL80211_MESHCONF_PATH_REFRESH_TIME,
4329	NL80211_MESHCONF_MIN_DISCOVERY_TIMEOUT,
4330	NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_ACTIVE_PATH_TIMEOUT,
4331	NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_PREQ_MIN_INTERVAL,
4332	NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_NET_DIAM_TRVS_TIME,
4333	NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_ROOTMODE,
4334	NL80211_MESHCONF_ELEMENT_TTL,
4335	NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_RANN_INTERVAL,
4336	NL80211_MESHCONF_GATE_ANNOUNCEMENTS,
4337	NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_PERR_MIN_INTERVAL,
4338	NL80211_MESHCONF_FORWARDING,
4339	NL80211_MESHCONF_RSSI_THRESHOLD,
4340	NL80211_MESHCONF_SYNC_OFFSET_MAX_NEIGHBOR,
4341	NL80211_MESHCONF_HT_OPMODE,
4342	NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_PATH_TO_ROOT_TIMEOUT,
4343	NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_ROOT_INTERVAL,
4344	NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_CONFIRMATION_INTERVAL,
4345	NL80211_MESHCONF_POWER_MODE,
4346	NL80211_MESHCONF_AWAKE_WINDOW,
4347	NL80211_MESHCONF_PLINK_TIMEOUT,
4348	NL80211_MESHCONF_CONNECTED_TO_GATE,
4349	NL80211_MESHCONF_NOLEARN,
4350	NL80211_MESHCONF_CONNECTED_TO_AS,
4351
4352	/* keep last */
4353	__NL80211_MESHCONF_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
4354	NL80211_MESHCONF_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_MESHCONF_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
4355};
4356
4357/**
4358 * enum nl80211_mesh_setup_params - mesh setup parameters
4359 *
4360 * Mesh setup parameters.  These are used to start/join a mesh and cannot be
4361 * changed while the mesh is active.
4362 *
4363 * @__NL80211_MESH_SETUP_INVALID: Internal use
4364 *
4365 * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ENABLE_VENDOR_PATH_SEL: Enable this option to use a
4366 *	vendor specific path selection algorithm or disable it to use the
4367 *	default HWMP.
4368 *
4369 * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ENABLE_VENDOR_METRIC: Enable this option to use a
4370 *	vendor specific path metric or disable it to use the default Airtime
4371 *	metric.
4372 *
4373 * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_IE: Information elements for this mesh, for instance, a
4374 *	robust security network ie, or a vendor specific information element
4375 *	that vendors will use to identify the path selection methods and
4376 *	metrics in use.
4377 *
4378 * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AUTH: Enable this option if an authentication
4379 *	daemon will be authenticating mesh candidates.
4380 *
4381 * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AMPE: Enable this option if an authentication
4382 *	daemon will be securing peer link frames.  AMPE is a secured version of
4383 *	Mesh Peering Management (MPM) and is implemented with the assistance of
4384 *	a userspace daemon.  When this flag is set, the kernel will send peer
4385 *	management frames to a userspace daemon that will implement AMPE
4386 *	functionality (security capabilities selection, key confirmation, and
4387 *	key management).  When the flag is unset (default), the kernel can
4388 *	autonomously complete (unsecured) mesh peering without the need of a
4389 *	userspace daemon.
4390 *
4391 * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ENABLE_VENDOR_SYNC: Enable this option to use a
4392 *	vendor specific synchronization method or disable it to use the default
4393 *	neighbor offset synchronization
4394 *
4395 * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_MPM: Enable this option if userspace will
4396 *	implement an MPM which handles peer allocation and state.
4397 *
4398 * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_AUTH_PROTOCOL: Inform the kernel of the authentication
4399 *	method (u8, as defined in IEEE 8.4.2.100.6, e.g. 0x1 for SAE).
4400 *	Default is no authentication method required.
4401 *
4402 * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ATTR_MAX: highest possible mesh setup attribute number
4403 *
4404 * @__NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: Internal use
4405 */
4406enum nl80211_mesh_setup_params {
4407	__NL80211_MESH_SETUP_INVALID,
4408	NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ENABLE_VENDOR_PATH_SEL,
4409	NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ENABLE_VENDOR_METRIC,
4410	NL80211_MESH_SETUP_IE,
4411	NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AUTH,
4412	NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AMPE,
4413	NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ENABLE_VENDOR_SYNC,
4414	NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_MPM,
4415	NL80211_MESH_SETUP_AUTH_PROTOCOL,
4416
4417	/* keep last */
4418	__NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
4419	NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
4420};
4421
4422/**
4423 * enum nl80211_txq_attr - TX queue parameter attributes
4424 * @__NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_INVALID: Attribute number 0 is reserved
4425 * @NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AC: AC identifier (NL80211_AC_*)
4426 * @NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_TXOP: Maximum burst time in units of 32 usecs, 0 meaning
4427 *	disabled
4428 * @NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_CWMIN: Minimum contention window [a value of the form
4429 *	2^n-1 in the range 1..32767]
4430 * @NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_CWMAX: Maximum contention window [a value of the form
4431 *	2^n-1 in the range 1..32767]
4432 * @NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AIFS: Arbitration interframe space [0..255]
4433 * @__NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: Internal
4434 * @NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_MAX: Maximum TXQ attribute number
4435 */
4436enum nl80211_txq_attr {
4437	__NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_INVALID,
4438	NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AC,
4439	NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_TXOP,
4440	NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_CWMIN,
4441	NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_CWMAX,
4442	NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AIFS,
4443
4444	/* keep last */
4445	__NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
4446	NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
4447};
4448
4449enum nl80211_ac {
4450	NL80211_AC_VO,
4451	NL80211_AC_VI,
4452	NL80211_AC_BE,
4453	NL80211_AC_BK,
4454	NL80211_NUM_ACS
4455};
4456
4457/* backward compat */
4458#define NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_QUEUE	NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AC
4459#define NL80211_TXQ_Q_VO	NL80211_AC_VO
4460#define NL80211_TXQ_Q_VI	NL80211_AC_VI
4461#define NL80211_TXQ_Q_BE	NL80211_AC_BE
4462#define NL80211_TXQ_Q_BK	NL80211_AC_BK
4463
4464/**
4465 * enum nl80211_channel_type - channel type
4466 * @NL80211_CHAN_NO_HT: 20 MHz, non-HT channel
4467 * @NL80211_CHAN_HT20: 20 MHz HT channel
4468 * @NL80211_CHAN_HT40MINUS: HT40 channel, secondary channel
4469 *	below the control channel
4470 * @NL80211_CHAN_HT40PLUS: HT40 channel, secondary channel
4471 *	above the control channel
4472 */
4473enum nl80211_channel_type {
4474	NL80211_CHAN_NO_HT,
4475	NL80211_CHAN_HT20,
4476	NL80211_CHAN_HT40MINUS,
4477	NL80211_CHAN_HT40PLUS
4478};
4479
4480/**
4481 * enum nl80211_key_mode - Key mode
4482 *
4483 * @NL80211_KEY_RX_TX: (Default)
4484 *	Key can be used for Rx and Tx immediately
4485 *
4486 * The following modes can only be selected for unicast keys and when the
4487 * driver supports @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_EXT_KEY_ID:
4488 *
4489 * @NL80211_KEY_NO_TX: Only allowed in combination with @NL80211_CMD_NEW_KEY:
4490 *	Unicast key can only be used for Rx, Tx not allowed, yet
4491 * @NL80211_KEY_SET_TX: Only allowed in combination with @NL80211_CMD_SET_KEY:
4492 *	The unicast key identified by idx and mac is cleared for Tx and becomes
4493 *	the preferred Tx key for the station.
4494 */
4495enum nl80211_key_mode {
4496	NL80211_KEY_RX_TX,
4497	NL80211_KEY_NO_TX,
4498	NL80211_KEY_SET_TX
4499};
4500
4501/**
4502 * enum nl80211_chan_width - channel width definitions
4503 *
4504 * These values are used with the %NL80211_ATTR_CHANNEL_WIDTH
4505 * attribute.
4506 *
4507 * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20_NOHT: 20 MHz, non-HT channel
4508 * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20: 20 MHz HT channel
4509 * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40: 40 MHz channel, the %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1
4510 *	attribute must be provided as well
4511 * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_80: 80 MHz channel, the %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1
4512 *	attribute must be provided as well
4513 * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_80P80: 80+80 MHz channel, the %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1
4514 *	and %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ2 attributes must be provided as well
4515 * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_160: 160 MHz channel, the %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1
4516 *	attribute must be provided as well
4517 * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5: 5 MHz OFDM channel
4518 * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10: 10 MHz OFDM channel
4519 * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_1: 1 MHz OFDM channel
4520 * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_2: 2 MHz OFDM channel
4521 * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_4: 4 MHz OFDM channel
4522 * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_8: 8 MHz OFDM channel
4523 * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_16: 16 MHz OFDM channel
4524 */
4525enum nl80211_chan_width {
4526	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20_NOHT,
4527	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20,
4528	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40,
4529	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_80,
4530	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_80P80,
4531	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_160,
4532	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5,
4533	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10,
4534	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_1,
4535	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_2,
4536	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_4,
4537	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_8,
4538	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_16,
4539};
4540
4541/**
4542 * enum nl80211_bss_scan_width - control channel width for a BSS
4543 *
4544 * These values are used with the %NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH attribute.
4545 *
4546 * @NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_20: control channel is 20 MHz wide or compatible
4547 * @NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_10: control channel is 10 MHz wide
4548 * @NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_5: control channel is 5 MHz wide
4549 * @NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_1: control channel is 1 MHz wide
4550 * @NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_2: control channel is 2 MHz wide
4551 */
4552enum nl80211_bss_scan_width {
4553	NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_20,
4554	NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_10,
4555	NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_5,
4556	NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_1,
4557	NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_2,
4558};
4559
4560/**
4561 * enum nl80211_bss - netlink attributes for a BSS
4562 *
4563 * @__NL80211_BSS_INVALID: invalid
4564 * @NL80211_BSS_BSSID: BSSID of the BSS (6 octets)
4565 * @NL80211_BSS_FREQUENCY: frequency in MHz (u32)
4566 * @NL80211_BSS_TSF: TSF of the received probe response/beacon (u64)
4567 *	(if @NL80211_BSS_PRESP_DATA is present then this is known to be
4568 *	from a probe response, otherwise it may be from the same beacon
4569 *	that the NL80211_BSS_BEACON_TSF will be from)
4570 * @NL80211_BSS_BEACON_INTERVAL: beacon interval of the (I)BSS (u16)
4571 * @NL80211_BSS_CAPABILITY: capability field (CPU order, u16)
4572 * @NL80211_BSS_INFORMATION_ELEMENTS: binary attribute containing the
4573 *	raw information elements from the probe response/beacon (bin);
4574 *	if the %NL80211_BSS_BEACON_IES attribute is present and the data is
4575 *	different then the IEs here are from a Probe Response frame; otherwise
4576 *	they are from a Beacon frame.
4577 *	However, if the driver does not indicate the source of the IEs, these
4578 *	IEs may be from either frame subtype.
4579 *	If present, the @NL80211_BSS_PRESP_DATA attribute indicates that the
4580 *	data here is known to be from a probe response, without any heuristics.
4581 * @NL80211_BSS_SIGNAL_MBM: signal strength of probe response/beacon
4582 *	in mBm (100 * dBm) (s32)
4583 * @NL80211_BSS_SIGNAL_UNSPEC: signal strength of the probe response/beacon
4584 *	in unspecified units, scaled to 0..100 (u8)
4585 * @NL80211_BSS_STATUS: status, if this BSS is "used"
4586 * @NL80211_BSS_SEEN_MS_AGO: age of this BSS entry in ms
4587 * @NL80211_BSS_BEACON_IES: binary attribute containing the raw information
4588 *	elements from a Beacon frame (bin); not present if no Beacon frame has
4589 *	yet been received
4590 * @NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH: channel width of the control channel
4591 *	(u32, enum nl80211_bss_scan_width)
4592 * @NL80211_BSS_BEACON_TSF: TSF of the last received beacon (u64)
4593 *	(not present if no beacon frame has been received yet)
4594 * @NL80211_BSS_PRESP_DATA: the data in @NL80211_BSS_INFORMATION_ELEMENTS and
4595 *	@NL80211_BSS_TSF is known to be from a probe response (flag attribute)
4596 * @NL80211_BSS_LAST_SEEN_BOOTTIME: CLOCK_BOOTTIME timestamp when this entry
4597 *	was last updated by a received frame. The value is expected to be
4598 *	accurate to about 10ms. (u64, nanoseconds)
4599 * @NL80211_BSS_PAD: attribute used for padding for 64-bit alignment
4600 * @NL80211_BSS_PARENT_TSF: the time at the start of reception of the first
4601 *	octet of the timestamp field of the last beacon/probe received for
4602 *	this BSS. The time is the TSF of the BSS specified by
4603 *	@NL80211_BSS_PARENT_BSSID. (u64).
4604 * @NL80211_BSS_PARENT_BSSID: the BSS according to which @NL80211_BSS_PARENT_TSF
4605 *	is set.
4606 * @NL80211_BSS_CHAIN_SIGNAL: per-chain signal strength of last BSS update.
4607 *	Contains a nested array of signal strength attributes (u8, dBm),
4608 *	using the nesting index as the antenna number.
4609 * @NL80211_BSS_FREQUENCY_OFFSET: frequency offset in KHz
4610 * @__NL80211_BSS_AFTER_LAST: internal
4611 * @NL80211_BSS_MAX: highest BSS attribute
4612 */
4613enum nl80211_bss {
4614	__NL80211_BSS_INVALID,
4615	NL80211_BSS_BSSID,
4616	NL80211_BSS_FREQUENCY,
4617	NL80211_BSS_TSF,
4618	NL80211_BSS_BEACON_INTERVAL,
4619	NL80211_BSS_CAPABILITY,
4620	NL80211_BSS_INFORMATION_ELEMENTS,
4621	NL80211_BSS_SIGNAL_MBM,
4622	NL80211_BSS_SIGNAL_UNSPEC,
4623	NL80211_BSS_STATUS,
4624	NL80211_BSS_SEEN_MS_AGO,
4625	NL80211_BSS_BEACON_IES,
4626	NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH,
4627	NL80211_BSS_BEACON_TSF,
4628	NL80211_BSS_PRESP_DATA,
4629	NL80211_BSS_LAST_SEEN_BOOTTIME,
4630	NL80211_BSS_PAD,
4631	NL80211_BSS_PARENT_TSF,
4632	NL80211_BSS_PARENT_BSSID,
4633	NL80211_BSS_CHAIN_SIGNAL,
4634	NL80211_BSS_FREQUENCY_OFFSET,
4635
4636	/* keep last */
4637	__NL80211_BSS_AFTER_LAST,
4638	NL80211_BSS_MAX = __NL80211_BSS_AFTER_LAST - 1
4639};
4640
4641/**
4642 * enum nl80211_bss_status - BSS "status"
4643 * @NL80211_BSS_STATUS_AUTHENTICATED: Authenticated with this BSS.
4644 *	Note that this is no longer used since cfg80211 no longer
4645 *	keeps track of whether or not authentication was done with
4646 *	a given BSS.
4647 * @NL80211_BSS_STATUS_ASSOCIATED: Associated with this BSS.
4648 * @NL80211_BSS_STATUS_IBSS_JOINED: Joined to this IBSS.
4649 *
4650 * The BSS status is a BSS attribute in scan dumps, which
4651 * indicates the status the interface has wrt. this BSS.
4652 */
4653enum nl80211_bss_status {
4654	NL80211_BSS_STATUS_AUTHENTICATED,
4655	NL80211_BSS_STATUS_ASSOCIATED,
4656	NL80211_BSS_STATUS_IBSS_JOINED,
4657};
4658
4659/**
4660 * enum nl80211_auth_type - AuthenticationType
4661 *
4662 * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_OPEN_SYSTEM: Open System authentication
4663 * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_SHARED_KEY: Shared Key authentication (WEP only)
4664 * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FT: Fast BSS Transition (IEEE 802.11r)
4665 * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_NETWORK_EAP: Network EAP (some Cisco APs and mainly LEAP)
4666 * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_SAE: Simultaneous authentication of equals
4667 * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FILS_SK: Fast Initial Link Setup shared key
4668 * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FILS_SK_PFS: Fast Initial Link Setup shared key with PFS
4669 * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FILS_PK: Fast Initial Link Setup public key
4670 * @__NL80211_AUTHTYPE_NUM: internal
4671 * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_MAX: maximum valid auth algorithm
4672 * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_AUTOMATIC: determine automatically (if necessary by
4673 *	trying multiple times); this is invalid in netlink -- leave out
4674 *	the attribute for this on CONNECT commands.
4675 */
4676enum nl80211_auth_type {
4677	NL80211_AUTHTYPE_OPEN_SYSTEM,
4678	NL80211_AUTHTYPE_SHARED_KEY,
4679	NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FT,
4680	NL80211_AUTHTYPE_NETWORK_EAP,
4681	NL80211_AUTHTYPE_SAE,
4682	NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FILS_SK,
4683	NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FILS_SK_PFS,
4684	NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FILS_PK,
4685
4686	/* keep last */
4687	__NL80211_AUTHTYPE_NUM,
4688	NL80211_AUTHTYPE_MAX = __NL80211_AUTHTYPE_NUM - 1,
4689	NL80211_AUTHTYPE_AUTOMATIC
4690};
4691
4692/**
4693 * enum nl80211_key_type - Key Type
4694 * @NL80211_KEYTYPE_GROUP: Group (broadcast/multicast) key
4695 * @NL80211_KEYTYPE_PAIRWISE: Pairwise (unicast/individual) key
4696 * @NL80211_KEYTYPE_PEERKEY: PeerKey (DLS)
4697 * @NUM_NL80211_KEYTYPES: number of defined key types
4698 */
4699enum nl80211_key_type {
4700	NL80211_KEYTYPE_GROUP,
4701	NL80211_KEYTYPE_PAIRWISE,
4702	NL80211_KEYTYPE_PEERKEY,
4703
4704	NUM_NL80211_KEYTYPES
4705};
4706
4707/**
4708 * enum nl80211_mfp - Management frame protection state
4709 * @NL80211_MFP_NO: Management frame protection not used
4710 * @NL80211_MFP_REQUIRED: Management frame protection required
4711 * @NL80211_MFP_OPTIONAL: Management frame protection is optional
4712 */
4713enum nl80211_mfp {
4714	NL80211_MFP_NO,
4715	NL80211_MFP_REQUIRED,
4716	NL80211_MFP_OPTIONAL,
4717};
4718
4719enum nl80211_wpa_versions {
4720	NL80211_WPA_VERSION_1 = 1 << 0,
4721	NL80211_WPA_VERSION_2 = 1 << 1,
4722	NL80211_WPA_VERSION_3 = 1 << 2,
4723};
4724
4725/**
4726 * enum nl80211_key_default_types - key default types
4727 * @__NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPE_INVALID: invalid
4728 * @NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPE_UNICAST: key should be used as default
4729 *	unicast key
4730 * @NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPE_MULTICAST: key should be used as default
4731 *	multicast key
4732 * @NUM_NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPES: number of default types
4733 */
4734enum nl80211_key_default_types {
4735	__NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPE_INVALID,
4736	NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPE_UNICAST,
4737	NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPE_MULTICAST,
4738
4739	NUM_NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPES
4740};
4741
4742/**
4743 * enum nl80211_key_attributes - key attributes
4744 * @__NL80211_KEY_INVALID: invalid
4745 * @NL80211_KEY_DATA: (temporal) key data; for TKIP this consists of
4746 *	16 bytes encryption key followed by 8 bytes each for TX and RX MIC
4747 *	keys
4748 * @NL80211_KEY_IDX: key ID (u8, 0-3)
4749 * @NL80211_KEY_CIPHER: key cipher suite (u32, as defined by IEEE 802.11
4750 *	section 7.3.2.25.1, e.g. 0x000FAC04)
4751 * @NL80211_KEY_SEQ: transmit key sequence number (IV/PN) for TKIP and
4752 *	CCMP keys, each six bytes in little endian
4753 * @NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT: flag indicating default key
4754 * @NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_MGMT: flag indicating default management key
4755 * @NL80211_KEY_TYPE: the key type from enum nl80211_key_type, if not
4756 *	specified the default depends on whether a MAC address was
4757 *	given with the command using the key or not (u32)
4758 * @NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPES: A nested attribute containing flags
4759 *	attributes, specifying what a key should be set as default as.
4760 *	See &enum nl80211_key_default_types.
4761 * @NL80211_KEY_MODE: the mode from enum nl80211_key_mode.
4762 *	Defaults to @NL80211_KEY_RX_TX.
4763 * @NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_BEACON: flag indicating default Beacon frame key
4764 *
4765 * @__NL80211_KEY_AFTER_LAST: internal
4766 * @NL80211_KEY_MAX: highest key attribute
4767 */
4768enum nl80211_key_attributes {
4769	__NL80211_KEY_INVALID,
4770	NL80211_KEY_DATA,
4771	NL80211_KEY_IDX,
4772	NL80211_KEY_CIPHER,
4773	NL80211_KEY_SEQ,
4774	NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT,
4775	NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_MGMT,
4776	NL80211_KEY_TYPE,
4777	NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPES,
4778	NL80211_KEY_MODE,
4779	NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_BEACON,
4780
4781	/* keep last */
4782	__NL80211_KEY_AFTER_LAST,
4783	NL80211_KEY_MAX = __NL80211_KEY_AFTER_LAST - 1
4784};
4785
4786/**
4787 * enum nl80211_tx_rate_attributes - TX rate set attributes
4788 * @__NL80211_TXRATE_INVALID: invalid
4789 * @NL80211_TXRATE_LEGACY: Legacy (non-MCS) rates allowed for TX rate selection
4790 *	in an array of rates as defined in IEEE 802.11 7.3.2.2 (u8 values with
4791 *	1 = 500 kbps) but without the IE length restriction (at most
4792 *	%NL80211_MAX_SUPP_RATES in a single array).
4793 * @NL80211_TXRATE_HT: HT (MCS) rates allowed for TX rate selection
4794 *	in an array of MCS numbers.
4795 * @NL80211_TXRATE_VHT: VHT rates allowed for TX rate selection,
4796 *	see &struct nl80211_txrate_vht
4797 * @NL80211_TXRATE_GI: configure GI, see &enum nl80211_txrate_gi
4798 * @NL80211_TXRATE_HE: HE rates allowed for TX rate selection,
4799 *	see &struct nl80211_txrate_he
4800 * @NL80211_TXRATE_HE_GI: configure HE GI, 0.8us, 1.6us and 3.2us.
4801 * @NL80211_TXRATE_HE_LTF: configure HE LTF, 1XLTF, 2XLTF and 4XLTF.
4802 * @__NL80211_TXRATE_AFTER_LAST: internal
4803 * @NL80211_TXRATE_MAX: highest TX rate attribute
4804 */
4805enum nl80211_tx_rate_attributes {
4806	__NL80211_TXRATE_INVALID,
4807	NL80211_TXRATE_LEGACY,
4808	NL80211_TXRATE_HT,
4809	NL80211_TXRATE_VHT,
4810	NL80211_TXRATE_GI,
4811	NL80211_TXRATE_HE,
4812	NL80211_TXRATE_HE_GI,
4813	NL80211_TXRATE_HE_LTF,
4814
4815	/* keep last */
4816	__NL80211_TXRATE_AFTER_LAST,
4817	NL80211_TXRATE_MAX = __NL80211_TXRATE_AFTER_LAST - 1
4818};
4819
4820#define NL80211_TXRATE_MCS NL80211_TXRATE_HT
4821#define NL80211_VHT_NSS_MAX		8
4822
4823/**
4824 * struct nl80211_txrate_vht - VHT MCS/NSS txrate bitmap
4825 * @mcs: MCS bitmap table for each NSS (array index 0 for 1 stream, etc.)
4826 */
4827struct nl80211_txrate_vht {
4828	__u16 mcs[NL80211_VHT_NSS_MAX];
4829};
4830
4831#define NL80211_HE_NSS_MAX		8
4832/**
4833 * struct nl80211_txrate_he - HE MCS/NSS txrate bitmap
4834 * @mcs: MCS bitmap table for each NSS (array index 0 for 1 stream, etc.)
4835 */
4836struct nl80211_txrate_he {
4837	__u16 mcs[NL80211_HE_NSS_MAX];
4838};
4839
4840enum nl80211_txrate_gi {
4841	NL80211_TXRATE_DEFAULT_GI,
4842	NL80211_TXRATE_FORCE_SGI,
4843	NL80211_TXRATE_FORCE_LGI,
4844};
4845
4846/**
4847 * enum nl80211_band - Frequency band
4848 * @NL80211_BAND_2GHZ: 2.4 GHz ISM band
4849 * @NL80211_BAND_5GHZ: around 5 GHz band (4.9 - 5.7 GHz)
4850 * @NL80211_BAND_60GHZ: around 60 GHz band (58.32 - 69.12 GHz)
4851 * @NL80211_BAND_6GHZ: around 6 GHz band (5.9 - 7.2 GHz)
4852 * @NL80211_BAND_S1GHZ: around 900MHz, supported by S1G PHYs
4853 * @NUM_NL80211_BANDS: number of bands, avoid using this in userspace
4854 *	since newer kernel versions may support more bands
4855 */
4856enum nl80211_band {
4857	NL80211_BAND_2GHZ,
4858	NL80211_BAND_5GHZ,
4859	NL80211_BAND_60GHZ,
4860	NL80211_BAND_6GHZ,
4861	NL80211_BAND_S1GHZ,
4862
4863	NUM_NL80211_BANDS,
4864};
4865
4866/**
4867 * enum nl80211_ps_state - powersave state
4868 * @NL80211_PS_DISABLED: powersave is disabled
4869 * @NL80211_PS_ENABLED: powersave is enabled
4870 */
4871enum nl80211_ps_state {
4872	NL80211_PS_DISABLED,
4873	NL80211_PS_ENABLED,
4874};
4875
4876/**
4877 * enum nl80211_attr_cqm - connection quality monitor attributes
4878 * @__NL80211_ATTR_CQM_INVALID: invalid
4879 * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_THOLD: RSSI threshold in dBm. This value specifies
4880 *	the threshold for the RSSI level at which an event will be sent. Zero
4881 *	to disable.  Alternatively, if %NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CQM_RSSI_LIST is
4882 *	set, multiple values can be supplied as a low-to-high sorted array of
4883 *	threshold values in dBm.  Events will be sent when the RSSI value
4884 *	crosses any of the thresholds.
4885 * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_HYST: RSSI hysteresis in dBm. This value specifies
4886 *	the minimum amount the RSSI level must change after an event before a
4887 *	new event may be issued (to reduce effects of RSSI oscillation).
4888 * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_THRESHOLD_EVENT: RSSI threshold event
4889 * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_PKT_LOSS_EVENT: a u32 value indicating that this many
4890 *	consecutive packets were not acknowledged by the peer
4891 * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_RATE: TX error rate in %. Minimum % of TX failures
4892 *	during the given %NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_INTVL before an
4893 *	%NL80211_CMD_NOTIFY_CQM with reported %NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_RATE and
4894 *	%NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_PKTS is generated.
4895 * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_PKTS: number of attempted packets in a given
4896 *	%NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_INTVL before %NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_RATE is
4897 *	checked.
4898 * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_INTVL: interval in seconds. Specifies the periodic
4899 *	interval in which %NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_PKTS and
4900 *	%NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_RATE must be satisfied before generating an
4901 *	%NL80211_CMD_NOTIFY_CQM. Set to 0 to turn off TX error reporting.
4902 * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_BEACON_LOSS_EVENT: flag attribute that's set in a beacon
4903 *	loss event
4904 * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_LEVEL: the RSSI value in dBm that triggered the
4905 *	RSSI threshold event.
4906 * @__NL80211_ATTR_CQM_AFTER_LAST: internal
4907 * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_MAX: highest key attribute
4908 */
4909enum nl80211_attr_cqm {
4910	__NL80211_ATTR_CQM_INVALID,
4911	NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_THOLD,
4912	NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_HYST,
4913	NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_THRESHOLD_EVENT,
4914	NL80211_ATTR_CQM_PKT_LOSS_EVENT,
4915	NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_RATE,
4916	NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_PKTS,
4917	NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_INTVL,
4918	NL80211_ATTR_CQM_BEACON_LOSS_EVENT,
4919	NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_LEVEL,
4920
4921	/* keep last */
4922	__NL80211_ATTR_CQM_AFTER_LAST,
4923	NL80211_ATTR_CQM_MAX = __NL80211_ATTR_CQM_AFTER_LAST - 1
4924};
4925
4926/**
4927 * enum nl80211_cqm_rssi_threshold_event - RSSI threshold event
4928 * @NL80211_CQM_RSSI_THRESHOLD_EVENT_LOW: The RSSI level is lower than the
4929 *      configured threshold
4930 * @NL80211_CQM_RSSI_THRESHOLD_EVENT_HIGH: The RSSI is higher than the
4931 *      configured threshold
4932 * @NL80211_CQM_RSSI_BEACON_LOSS_EVENT: (reserved, never sent)
4933 */
4934enum nl80211_cqm_rssi_threshold_event {
4935	NL80211_CQM_RSSI_THRESHOLD_EVENT_LOW,
4936	NL80211_CQM_RSSI_THRESHOLD_EVENT_HIGH,
4937	NL80211_CQM_RSSI_BEACON_LOSS_EVENT,
4938};
4939
4940
4941/**
4942 * enum nl80211_tx_power_setting - TX power adjustment
4943 * @NL80211_TX_POWER_AUTOMATIC: automatically determine transmit power
4944 * @NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED: limit TX power by the mBm parameter
4945 * @NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED: fix TX power to the mBm parameter
4946 */
4947enum nl80211_tx_power_setting {
4948	NL80211_TX_POWER_AUTOMATIC,
4949	NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED,
4950	NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED,
4951};
4952
4953/**
4954 * enum nl80211_tid_config - TID config state
4955 * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ENABLE: Enable config for the TID
4956 * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_DISABLE: Disable config for the TID
4957 */
4958enum nl80211_tid_config {
4959	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ENABLE,
4960	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_DISABLE,
4961};
4962
4963/* enum nl80211_tx_rate_setting - TX rate configuration type
4964 * @NL80211_TX_RATE_AUTOMATIC: automatically determine TX rate
4965 * @NL80211_TX_RATE_LIMITED: limit the TX rate by the TX rate parameter
4966 * @NL80211_TX_RATE_FIXED: fix TX rate to the TX rate parameter
4967 */
4968enum nl80211_tx_rate_setting {
4969	NL80211_TX_RATE_AUTOMATIC,
4970	NL80211_TX_RATE_LIMITED,
4971	NL80211_TX_RATE_FIXED,
4972};
4973
4974/* enum nl80211_tid_config_attr - TID specific configuration.
4975 * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_PAD: pad attribute for 64-bit values
4976 * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_VIF_SUPP: a bitmap (u64) of attributes supported
4977 *	for per-vif configuration; doesn't list the ones that are generic
4978 *	(%NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TIDS, %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_OVERRIDE).
4979 * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_PEER_SUPP: same as the previous per-vif one, but
4980 *	per peer instead.
4981 * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_OVERRIDE: flag attribue, if set indicates
4982 *	that the new configuration overrides all previous peer
4983 *	configurations, otherwise previous peer specific configurations
4984 *	should be left untouched.
4985 * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TIDS: a bitmask value of TIDs (bit 0 to 7)
4986 *	Its type is u16.
4987 * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_NOACK: Configure ack policy for the TID.
4988 *	specified in %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TID. see %enum nl80211_tid_config.
4989 *	Its type is u8.
4990 * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RETRY_SHORT: Number of retries used with data frame
4991 *	transmission, user-space sets this configuration in
4992 *	&NL80211_CMD_SET_TID_CONFIG. It is u8 type, min value is 1 and
4993 *	the max value is advertised by the driver in this attribute on
4994 *	output in wiphy capabilities.
4995 * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RETRY_LONG: Number of retries used with data frame
4996 *	transmission, user-space sets this configuration in
4997 *	&NL80211_CMD_SET_TID_CONFIG. Its type is u8, min value is 1 and
4998 *	the max value is advertised by the driver in this attribute on
4999 *	output in wiphy capabilities.
5000 * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_AMPDU_CTRL: Enable/Disable MPDU aggregation
5001 *	for the TIDs specified in %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TIDS.
5002 *	Its type is u8, using the values from &nl80211_tid_config.
5003 * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RTSCTS_CTRL: Enable/Disable RTS_CTS for the TIDs
5004 *	specified in %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TIDS. It is u8 type, using
5005 *	the values from &nl80211_tid_config.
5006 * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_AMSDU_CTRL: Enable/Disable MSDU aggregation
5007 *	for the TIDs specified in %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TIDS.
5008 *	Its type is u8, using the values from &nl80211_tid_config.
5009 * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TX_RATE_TYPE: This attribute will be useful
5010 *	to notfiy the driver that what type of txrate should be used
5011 *	for the TIDs specified in %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TIDS. using
5012 *	the values form &nl80211_tx_rate_setting.
5013 * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TX_RATE: Data frame TX rate mask should be applied
5014 *	with the parameters passed through %NL80211_ATTR_TX_RATES.
5015 *	configuration is applied to the data frame for the tid to that connected
5016 *	station.
5017 */
5018enum nl80211_tid_config_attr {
5019	__NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_INVALID,
5020	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_PAD,
5021	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_VIF_SUPP,
5022	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_PEER_SUPP,
5023	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_OVERRIDE,
5024	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TIDS,
5025	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_NOACK,
5026	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RETRY_SHORT,
5027	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RETRY_LONG,
5028	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_AMPDU_CTRL,
5029	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RTSCTS_CTRL,
5030	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_AMSDU_CTRL,
5031	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TX_RATE_TYPE,
5032	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TX_RATE,
5033
5034	/* keep last */
5035	__NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
5036	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
5037};
5038
5039/**
5040 * enum nl80211_packet_pattern_attr - packet pattern attribute
5041 * @__NL80211_PKTPAT_INVALID: invalid number for nested attribute
5042 * @NL80211_PKTPAT_PATTERN: the pattern, values where the mask has
5043 *	a zero bit are ignored
5044 * @NL80211_PKTPAT_MASK: pattern mask, must be long enough to have
5045 *	a bit for each byte in the pattern. The lowest-order bit corresponds
5046 *	to the first byte of the pattern, but the bytes of the pattern are
5047 *	in a little-endian-like format, i.e. the 9th byte of the pattern
5048 *	corresponds to the lowest-order bit in the second byte of the mask.
5049 *	For example: The match 00:xx:00:00:xx:00:00:00:00:xx:xx:xx (where
5050 *	xx indicates "don't care") would be represented by a pattern of
5051 *	twelve zero bytes, and a mask of "0xed,0x01".
5052 *	Note that the pattern matching is done as though frames were not
5053 *	802.11 frames but 802.3 frames, i.e. the frame is fully unpacked
5054 *	first (including SNAP header unpacking) and then matched.
5055 * @NL80211_PKTPAT_OFFSET: packet offset, pattern is matched after
5056 *	these fixed number of bytes of received packet
5057 * @NUM_NL80211_PKTPAT: number of attributes
5058 * @MAX_NL80211_PKTPAT: max attribute number
5059 */
5060enum nl80211_packet_pattern_attr {
5061	__NL80211_PKTPAT_INVALID,
5062	NL80211_PKTPAT_MASK,
5063	NL80211_PKTPAT_PATTERN,
5064	NL80211_PKTPAT_OFFSET,
5065
5066	NUM_NL80211_PKTPAT,
5067	MAX_NL80211_PKTPAT = NUM_NL80211_PKTPAT - 1,
5068};
5069
5070/**
5071 * struct nl80211_pattern_support - packet pattern support information
5072 * @max_patterns: maximum number of patterns supported
5073 * @min_pattern_len: minimum length of each pattern
5074 * @max_pattern_len: maximum length of each pattern
5075 * @max_pkt_offset: maximum Rx packet offset
5076 *
5077 * This struct is carried in %NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_PKT_PATTERN when
5078 * that is part of %NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS_SUPPORTED or in
5079 * %NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_PKT_PATTERN when that is part of
5080 * %NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE in the capability information given
5081 * by the kernel to userspace.
5082 */
5083struct nl80211_pattern_support {
5084	__u32 max_patterns;
5085	__u32 min_pattern_len;
5086	__u32 max_pattern_len;
5087	__u32 max_pkt_offset;
5088} __attribute__((packed));
5089
5090/* only for backward compatibility */
5091#define __NL80211_WOWLAN_PKTPAT_INVALID __NL80211_PKTPAT_INVALID
5092#define NL80211_WOWLAN_PKTPAT_MASK NL80211_PKTPAT_MASK
5093#define NL80211_WOWLAN_PKTPAT_PATTERN NL80211_PKTPAT_PATTERN
5094#define NL80211_WOWLAN_PKTPAT_OFFSET NL80211_PKTPAT_OFFSET
5095#define NUM_NL80211_WOWLAN_PKTPAT NUM_NL80211_PKTPAT
5096#define MAX_NL80211_WOWLAN_PKTPAT MAX_NL80211_PKTPAT
5097#define nl80211_wowlan_pattern_support nl80211_pattern_support
5098
5099/**
5100 * enum nl80211_wowlan_triggers - WoWLAN trigger definitions
5101 * @__NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_INVALID: invalid number for nested attributes
5102 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_ANY: wake up on any activity, do not really put
5103 *	the chip into a special state -- works best with chips that have
5104 *	support for low-power operation already (flag)
5105 *	Note that this mode is incompatible with all of the others, if
5106 *	any others are even supported by the device.
5107 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_DISCONNECT: wake up on disconnect, the way disconnect
5108 *	is detected is implementation-specific (flag)
5109 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_MAGIC_PKT: wake up on magic packet (6x 0xff, followed
5110 *	by 16 repetitions of MAC addr, anywhere in payload) (flag)
5111 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_PKT_PATTERN: wake up on the specified packet patterns
5112 *	which are passed in an array of nested attributes, each nested attribute
5113 *	defining a with attributes from &struct nl80211_wowlan_trig_pkt_pattern.
5114 *	Each pattern defines a wakeup packet. Packet offset is associated with
5115 *	each pattern which is used while matching the pattern. The matching is
5116 *	done on the MSDU, i.e. as though the packet was an 802.3 packet, so the
5117 *	pattern matching is done after the packet is converted to the MSDU.
5118 *
5119 *	In %NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS_SUPPORTED, it is a binary attribute
5120 *	carrying a &struct nl80211_pattern_support.
5121 *
5122 *	When reporting wakeup. it is a u32 attribute containing the 0-based
5123 *	index of the pattern that caused the wakeup, in the patterns passed
5124 *	to the kernel when configuring.
5125 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_GTK_REKEY_SUPPORTED: Not a real trigger, and cannot be
5126 *	used when setting, used only to indicate that GTK rekeying is supported
5127 *	by the device (flag)
5128 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_GTK_REKEY_FAILURE: wake up on GTK rekey failure (if
5129 *	done by the device) (flag)
5130 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_EAP_IDENT_REQUEST: wake up on EAP Identity Request
5131 *	packet (flag)
5132 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_4WAY_HANDSHAKE: wake up on 4-way handshake (flag)
5133 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_RFKILL_RELEASE: wake up when rfkill is released
5134 *	(on devices that have rfkill in the device) (flag)
5135 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_80211: For wakeup reporting only, contains
5136 *	the 802.11 packet that caused the wakeup, e.g. a deauth frame. The frame
5137 *	may be truncated, the @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_80211_LEN
5138 *	attribute contains the original length.
5139 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_80211_LEN: Original length of the 802.11
5140 *	packet, may be bigger than the @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_80211
5141 *	attribute if the packet was truncated somewhere.
5142 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_8023: For wakeup reporting only, contains the
5143 *	802.11 packet that caused the wakeup, e.g. a magic packet. The frame may
5144 *	be truncated, the @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_8023_LEN attribute
5145 *	contains the original length.
5146 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_8023_LEN: Original length of the 802.3
5147 *	packet, may be bigger than the @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_8023
5148 *	attribute if the packet was truncated somewhere.
5149 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_TCP_CONNECTION: TCP connection wake, see DOC section
5150 *	"TCP connection wakeup" for more details. This is a nested attribute
5151 *	containing the exact information for establishing and keeping alive
5152 *	the TCP connection.
5153 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_TCP_WAKEUP_MATCH: For wakeup reporting only, the
5154 *	wakeup packet was received on the TCP connection
5155 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_TCP_CONNLOST: For wakeup reporting only, the
5156 *	TCP connection was lost or failed to be established
5157 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_TCP_NOMORETOKENS: For wakeup reporting only,
5158 *	the TCP connection ran out of tokens to use for data to send to the
5159 *	service
5160 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_NET_DETECT: wake up when a configured network
5161 *	is detected.  This is a nested attribute that contains the
5162 *	same attributes used with @NL80211_CMD_START_SCHED_SCAN.  It
5163 *	specifies how the scan is performed (e.g. the interval, the
5164 *	channels to scan and the initial delay) as well as the scan
5165 *	results that will trigger a wake (i.e. the matchsets).  This
5166 *	attribute is also sent in a response to
5167 *	@NL80211_CMD_GET_WIPHY, indicating the number of match sets
5168 *	supported by the driver (u32).
5169 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_NET_DETECT_RESULTS: nested attribute
5170 *	containing an array with information about what triggered the
5171 *	wake up.  If no elements are present in the array, it means
5172 *	that the information is not available.  If more than one
5173 *	element is present, it means that more than one match
5174 *	occurred.
5175 *	Each element in the array is a nested attribute that contains
5176 *	one optional %NL80211_ATTR_SSID attribute and one optional
5177 *	%NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQUENCIES attribute.  At least one of
5178 *	these attributes must be present.  If
5179 *	%NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQUENCIES contains more than one
5180 *	frequency, it means that the match occurred in more than one
5181 *	channel.
5182 * @NUM_NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG: number of wake on wireless triggers
5183 * @MAX_NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG: highest wowlan trigger attribute number
5184 *
5185 * These nested attributes are used to configure the wakeup triggers and
5186 * to report the wakeup reason(s).
5187 */
5188enum nl80211_wowlan_triggers {
5189	__NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_INVALID,
5190	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_ANY,
5191	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_DISCONNECT,
5192	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_MAGIC_PKT,
5193	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_PKT_PATTERN,
5194	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_GTK_REKEY_SUPPORTED,
5195	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_GTK_REKEY_FAILURE,
5196	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_EAP_IDENT_REQUEST,
5197	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_4WAY_HANDSHAKE,
5198	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_RFKILL_RELEASE,
5199	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_80211,
5200	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_80211_LEN,
5201	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_8023,
5202	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_8023_LEN,
5203	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_TCP_CONNECTION,
5204	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_TCP_MATCH,
5205	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_TCP_CONNLOST,
5206	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_TCP_NOMORETOKENS,
5207	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_NET_DETECT,
5208	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_NET_DETECT_RESULTS,
5209
5210	/* keep last */
5211	NUM_NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG,
5212	MAX_NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG = NUM_NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG - 1
5213};
5214
5215/**
5216 * DOC: TCP connection wakeup
5217 *
5218 * Some devices can establish a TCP connection in order to be woken up by a
5219 * packet coming in from outside their network segment, or behind NAT. If
5220 * configured, the device will establish a TCP connection to the given
5221 * service, and periodically send data to that service. The first data
5222 * packet is usually transmitted after SYN/ACK, also ACKing the SYN/ACK.
5223 * The data packets can optionally include a (little endian) sequence
5224 * number (in the TCP payload!) that is generated by the device, and, also
5225 * optionally, a token from a list of tokens. This serves as a keep-alive
5226 * with the service, and for NATed connections, etc.
5227 *
5228 * During this keep-alive period, the server doesn't send any data to the
5229 * client. When receiving data, it is compared against the wakeup pattern
5230 * (and mask) and if it matches, the host is woken up. Similarly, if the
5231 * connection breaks or cannot be established to start with, the host is
5232 * also woken up.
5233 *
5234 * Developer's note: ARP offload is required for this, otherwise TCP
5235 * response packets might not go through correctly.
5236 */
5237
5238/**
5239 * struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_seq - WoWLAN TCP data sequence
5240 * @start: starting value
5241 * @offset: offset of sequence number in packet
5242 * @len: length of the sequence value to write, 1 through 4
5243 *
5244 * Note: don't confuse with the TCP sequence number(s), this is for the
5245 * keepalive packet payload. The actual value is written into the packet
5246 * in little endian.
5247 */
5248struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_seq {
5249	__u32 start, offset, len;
5250};
5251
5252/**
5253 * struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token - WoWLAN TCP data token config
5254 * @offset: offset of token in packet
5255 * @len: length of each token
5256 * @token_stream: stream of data to be used for the tokens, the length must
5257 *	be a multiple of @len for this to make sense
5258 */
5259struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token {
5260	__u32 offset, len;
5261	__u8 token_stream[];
5262};
5263
5264/**
5265 * struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token_feature - data token features
5266 * @min_len: minimum token length
5267 * @max_len: maximum token length
5268 * @bufsize: total available token buffer size (max size of @token_stream)
5269 */
5270struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token_feature {
5271	__u32 min_len, max_len, bufsize;
5272};
5273
5274/**
5275 * enum nl80211_wowlan_tcp_attrs - WoWLAN TCP connection parameters
5276 * @__NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_INVALID: invalid number for nested attributes
5277 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_SRC_IPV4: source IPv4 address (in network byte order)
5278 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DST_IPV4: destination IPv4 address
5279 *	(in network byte order)
5280 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DST_MAC: destination MAC address, this is given because
5281 *	route lookup when configured might be invalid by the time we suspend,
5282 *	and doing a route lookup when suspending is no longer possible as it
5283 *	might require ARP querying.
5284 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_SRC_PORT: source port (u16); optional, if not given a
5285 *	socket and port will be allocated
5286 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DST_PORT: destination port (u16)
5287 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_PAYLOAD: data packet payload, at least one byte.
5288 *	For feature advertising, a u32 attribute holding the maximum length
5289 *	of the data payload.
5290 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_PAYLOAD_SEQ: data packet sequence configuration
5291 *	(if desired), a &struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_seq. For feature
5292 *	advertising it is just a flag
5293 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_PAYLOAD_TOKEN: data packet token configuration,
5294 *	see &struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token and for advertising see
5295 *	&struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token_feature.
5296 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_INTERVAL: data interval in seconds, maximum
5297 *	interval in feature advertising (u32)
5298 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_WAKE_PAYLOAD: wake packet payload, for advertising a
5299 *	u32 attribute holding the maximum length
5300 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_WAKE_MASK: Wake packet payload mask, not used for
5301 *	feature advertising. The mask works like @NL80211_PKTPAT_MASK
5302 *	but on the TCP payload only.
5303 * @NUM_NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP: number of TCP attributes
5304 * @MAX_NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP: highest attribute number
5305 */
5306enum nl80211_wowlan_tcp_attrs {
5307	__NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_INVALID,
5308	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_SRC_IPV4,
5309	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DST_IPV4,
5310	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DST_MAC,
5311	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_SRC_PORT,
5312	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DST_PORT,
5313	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_PAYLOAD,
5314	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_PAYLOAD_SEQ,
5315	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_PAYLOAD_TOKEN,
5316	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_INTERVAL,
5317	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_WAKE_PAYLOAD,
5318	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_WAKE_MASK,
5319
5320	/* keep last */
5321	NUM_NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP,
5322	MAX_NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP = NUM_NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP - 1
5323};
5324
5325/**
5326 * struct nl80211_coalesce_rule_support - coalesce rule support information
5327 * @max_rules: maximum number of rules supported
5328 * @pat: packet pattern support information
5329 * @max_delay: maximum supported coalescing delay in msecs
5330 *
5331 * This struct is carried in %NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE in the
5332 * capability information given by the kernel to userspace.
5333 */
5334struct nl80211_coalesce_rule_support {
5335	__u32 max_rules;
5336	struct nl80211_pattern_support pat;
5337	__u32 max_delay;
5338} __attribute__((packed));
5339
5340/**
5341 * enum nl80211_attr_coalesce_rule - coalesce rule attribute
5342 * @__NL80211_COALESCE_RULE_INVALID: invalid number for nested attribute
5343 * @NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_DELAY: delay in msecs used for packet coalescing
5344 * @NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_CONDITION: condition for packet coalescence,
5345 *	see &enum nl80211_coalesce_condition.
5346 * @NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_PKT_PATTERN: packet offset, pattern is matched
5347 *	after these fixed number of bytes of received packet
5348 * @NUM_NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE: number of attributes
5349 * @NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_MAX: max attribute number
5350 */
5351enum nl80211_attr_coalesce_rule {
5352	__NL80211_COALESCE_RULE_INVALID,
5353	NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_DELAY,
5354	NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_CONDITION,
5355	NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_PKT_PATTERN,
5356
5357	/* keep last */
5358	NUM_NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE,
5359	NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_MAX = NUM_NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE - 1
5360};
5361
5362/**
5363 * enum nl80211_coalesce_condition - coalesce rule conditions
5364 * @NL80211_COALESCE_CONDITION_MATCH: coalaesce Rx packets when patterns
5365 *	in a rule are matched.
5366 * @NL80211_COALESCE_CONDITION_NO_MATCH: coalesce Rx packets when patterns
5367 *	in a rule are not matched.
5368 */
5369enum nl80211_coalesce_condition {
5370	NL80211_COALESCE_CONDITION_MATCH,
5371	NL80211_COALESCE_CONDITION_NO_MATCH
5372};
5373
5374/**
5375 * enum nl80211_iface_limit_attrs - limit attributes
5376 * @NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT_UNSPEC: (reserved)
5377 * @NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT_MAX: maximum number of interfaces that
5378 *	can be chosen from this set of interface types (u32)
5379 * @NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT_TYPES: nested attribute containing a
5380 *	flag attribute for each interface type in this set
5381 * @NUM_NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT: number of attributes
5382 * @MAX_NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT: highest attribute number
5383 */
5384enum nl80211_iface_limit_attrs {
5385	NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT_UNSPEC,
5386	NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT_MAX,
5387	NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT_TYPES,
5388
5389	/* keep last */
5390	NUM_NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT,
5391	MAX_NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT = NUM_NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT - 1
5392};
5393
5394/**
5395 * enum nl80211_if_combination_attrs -- interface combination attributes
5396 *
5397 * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_UNSPEC: (reserved)
5398 * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_LIMITS: Nested attributes containing the limits
5399 *	for given interface types, see &enum nl80211_iface_limit_attrs.
5400 * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_MAXNUM: u32 attribute giving the total number of
5401 *	interfaces that can be created in this group. This number doesn't
5402 *	apply to interfaces purely managed in software, which are listed
5403 *	in a separate attribute %NL80211_ATTR_INTERFACES_SOFTWARE.
5404 * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_STA_AP_BI_MATCH: flag attribute specifying that
5405 *	beacon intervals within this group must be all the same even for
5406 *	infrastructure and AP/GO combinations, i.e. the GO(s) must adopt
5407 *	the infrastructure network's beacon interval.
5408 * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_NUM_CHANNELS: u32 attribute specifying how many
5409 *	different channels may be used within this group.
5410 * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_RADAR_DETECT_WIDTHS: u32 attribute containing the bitmap
5411 *	of supported channel widths for radar detection.
5412 * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_RADAR_DETECT_REGIONS: u32 attribute containing the bitmap
5413 *	of supported regulatory regions for radar detection.
5414 * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_BI_MIN_GCD: u32 attribute specifying the minimum GCD of
5415 *	different beacon intervals supported by all the interface combinations
5416 *	in this group (if not present, all beacon intervals be identical).
5417 * @NUM_NL80211_IFACE_COMB: number of attributes
5418 * @MAX_NL80211_IFACE_COMB: highest attribute number
5419 *
5420 * Examples:
5421 *	limits = [ #{STA} <= 1, #{AP} <= 1 ], matching BI, channels = 1, max = 2
5422 *	=> allows an AP and a STA that must match BIs
5423 *
5424 *	numbers = [ #{AP, P2P-GO} <= 8 ], BI min gcd, channels = 1, max = 8,
5425 *	=> allows 8 of AP/GO that can have BI gcd >= min gcd
5426 *
5427 *	numbers = [ #{STA} <= 2 ], channels = 2, max = 2
5428 *	=> allows two STAs on different channels
5429 *
5430 *	numbers = [ #{STA} <= 1, #{P2P-client,P2P-GO} <= 3 ], max = 4
5431 *	=> allows a STA plus three P2P interfaces
5432 *
5433 * The list of these four possibilities could completely be contained
5434 * within the %NL80211_ATTR_INTERFACE_COMBINATIONS attribute to indicate
5435 * that any of these groups must match.
5436 *
5437 * "Combinations" of just a single interface will not be listed here,
5438 * a single interface of any valid interface type is assumed to always
5439 * be possible by itself. This means that implicitly, for each valid
5440 * interface type, the following group always exists:
5441 *	numbers = [ #{<type>} <= 1 ], channels = 1, max = 1
5442 */
5443enum nl80211_if_combination_attrs {
5444	NL80211_IFACE_COMB_UNSPEC,
5445	NL80211_IFACE_COMB_LIMITS,
5446	NL80211_IFACE_COMB_MAXNUM,
5447	NL80211_IFACE_COMB_STA_AP_BI_MATCH,
5448	NL80211_IFACE_COMB_NUM_CHANNELS,
5449	NL80211_IFACE_COMB_RADAR_DETECT_WIDTHS,
5450	NL80211_IFACE_COMB_RADAR_DETECT_REGIONS,
5451	NL80211_IFACE_COMB_BI_MIN_GCD,
5452
5453	/* keep last */
5454	NUM_NL80211_IFACE_COMB,
5455	MAX_NL80211_IFACE_COMB = NUM_NL80211_IFACE_COMB - 1
5456};
5457
5458
5459/**
5460 * enum nl80211_plink_state - state of a mesh peer link finite state machine
5461 *
5462 * @NL80211_PLINK_LISTEN: initial state, considered the implicit
5463 *	state of non existent mesh peer links
5464 * @NL80211_PLINK_OPN_SNT: mesh plink open frame has been sent to
5465 *	this mesh peer
5466 * @NL80211_PLINK_OPN_RCVD: mesh plink open frame has been received
5467 *	from this mesh peer
5468 * @NL80211_PLINK_CNF_RCVD: mesh plink confirm frame has been
5469 *	received from this mesh peer
5470 * @NL80211_PLINK_ESTAB: mesh peer link is established
5471 * @NL80211_PLINK_HOLDING: mesh peer link is being closed or cancelled
5472 * @NL80211_PLINK_BLOCKED: all frames transmitted from this mesh
5473 *	plink are discarded
5474 * @NUM_NL80211_PLINK_STATES: number of peer link states
5475 * @MAX_NL80211_PLINK_STATES: highest numerical value of plink states
5476 */
5477enum nl80211_plink_state {
5478	NL80211_PLINK_LISTEN,
5479	NL80211_PLINK_OPN_SNT,
5480	NL80211_PLINK_OPN_RCVD,
5481	NL80211_PLINK_CNF_RCVD,
5482	NL80211_PLINK_ESTAB,
5483	NL80211_PLINK_HOLDING,
5484	NL80211_PLINK_BLOCKED,
5485
5486	/* keep last */
5487	NUM_NL80211_PLINK_STATES,
5488	MAX_NL80211_PLINK_STATES = NUM_NL80211_PLINK_STATES - 1
5489};
5490
5491/**
5492 * enum nl80211_plink_action - actions to perform in mesh peers
5493 *
5494 * @NL80211_PLINK_ACTION_NO_ACTION: perform no action
5495 * @NL80211_PLINK_ACTION_OPEN: start mesh peer link establishment
5496 * @NL80211_PLINK_ACTION_BLOCK: block traffic from this mesh peer
5497 * @NUM_NL80211_PLINK_ACTIONS: number of possible actions
5498 */
5499enum plink_actions {
5500	NL80211_PLINK_ACTION_NO_ACTION,
5501	NL80211_PLINK_ACTION_OPEN,
5502	NL80211_PLINK_ACTION_BLOCK,
5503
5504	NUM_NL80211_PLINK_ACTIONS,
5505};
5506
5507
5508#define NL80211_KCK_LEN			16
5509#define NL80211_KEK_LEN			16
5510#define NL80211_KCK_EXT_LEN		24
5511#define NL80211_KEK_EXT_LEN		32
5512#define NL80211_REPLAY_CTR_LEN		8
5513
5514/**
5515 * enum nl80211_rekey_data - attributes for GTK rekey offload
5516 * @__NL80211_REKEY_DATA_INVALID: invalid number for nested attributes
5517 * @NL80211_REKEY_DATA_KEK: key encryption key (binary)
5518 * @NL80211_REKEY_DATA_KCK: key confirmation key (binary)
5519 * @NL80211_REKEY_DATA_REPLAY_CTR: replay counter (binary)
5520 * @NL80211_REKEY_DATA_AKM: AKM data (OUI, suite type)
5521 * @NUM_NL80211_REKEY_DATA: number of rekey attributes (internal)
5522 * @MAX_NL80211_REKEY_DATA: highest rekey attribute (internal)
5523 */
5524enum nl80211_rekey_data {
5525	__NL80211_REKEY_DATA_INVALID,
5526	NL80211_REKEY_DATA_KEK,
5527	NL80211_REKEY_DATA_KCK,
5528	NL80211_REKEY_DATA_REPLAY_CTR,
5529	NL80211_REKEY_DATA_AKM,
5530
5531	/* keep last */
5532	NUM_NL80211_REKEY_DATA,
5533	MAX_NL80211_REKEY_DATA = NUM_NL80211_REKEY_DATA - 1
5534};
5535
5536/**
5537 * enum nl80211_hidden_ssid - values for %NL80211_ATTR_HIDDEN_SSID
5538 * @NL80211_HIDDEN_SSID_NOT_IN_USE: do not hide SSID (i.e., broadcast it in
5539 *	Beacon frames)
5540 * @NL80211_HIDDEN_SSID_ZERO_LEN: hide SSID by using zero-length SSID element
5541 *	in Beacon frames
5542 * @NL80211_HIDDEN_SSID_ZERO_CONTENTS: hide SSID by using correct length of SSID
5543 *	element in Beacon frames but zero out each byte in the SSID
5544 */
5545enum nl80211_hidden_ssid {
5546	NL80211_HIDDEN_SSID_NOT_IN_USE,
5547	NL80211_HIDDEN_SSID_ZERO_LEN,
5548	NL80211_HIDDEN_SSID_ZERO_CONTENTS
5549};
5550
5551/**
5552 * enum nl80211_sta_wme_attr - station WME attributes
5553 * @__NL80211_STA_WME_INVALID: invalid number for nested attribute
5554 * @NL80211_STA_WME_UAPSD_QUEUES: bitmap of uapsd queues. the format
5555 *	is the same as the AC bitmap in the QoS info field.
5556 * @NL80211_STA_WME_MAX_SP: max service period. the format is the same
5557 *	as the MAX_SP field in the QoS info field (but already shifted down).
5558 * @__NL80211_STA_WME_AFTER_LAST: internal
5559 * @NL80211_STA_WME_MAX: highest station WME attribute
5560 */
5561enum nl80211_sta_wme_attr {
5562	__NL80211_STA_WME_INVALID,
5563	NL80211_STA_WME_UAPSD_QUEUES,
5564	NL80211_STA_WME_MAX_SP,
5565
5566	/* keep last */
5567	__NL80211_STA_WME_AFTER_LAST,
5568	NL80211_STA_WME_MAX = __NL80211_STA_WME_AFTER_LAST - 1
5569};
5570
5571/**
5572 * enum nl80211_pmksa_candidate_attr - attributes for PMKSA caching candidates
5573 * @__NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_INVALID: invalid number for nested attributes
5574 * @NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_INDEX: candidate index (u32; the smaller, the higher
5575 *	priority)
5576 * @NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_BSSID: candidate BSSID (6 octets)
5577 * @NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_PREAUTH: RSN pre-authentication supported (flag)
5578 * @NUM_NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE: number of PMKSA caching candidate attributes
5579 *	(internal)
5580 * @MAX_NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE: highest PMKSA caching candidate attribute
5581 *	(internal)
5582 */
5583enum nl80211_pmksa_candidate_attr {
5584	__NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_INVALID,
5585	NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_INDEX,
5586	NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_BSSID,
5587	NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_PREAUTH,
5588
5589	/* keep last */
5590	NUM_NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE,
5591	MAX_NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE = NUM_NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE - 1
5592};
5593
5594/**
5595 * enum nl80211_tdls_operation - values for %NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_OPERATION
5596 * @NL80211_TDLS_DISCOVERY_REQ: Send a TDLS discovery request
5597 * @NL80211_TDLS_SETUP: Setup TDLS link
5598 * @NL80211_TDLS_TEARDOWN: Teardown a TDLS link which is already established
5599 * @NL80211_TDLS_ENABLE_LINK: Enable TDLS link
5600 * @NL80211_TDLS_DISABLE_LINK: Disable TDLS link
5601 */
5602enum nl80211_tdls_operation {
5603	NL80211_TDLS_DISCOVERY_REQ,
5604	NL80211_TDLS_SETUP,
5605	NL80211_TDLS_TEARDOWN,
5606	NL80211_TDLS_ENABLE_LINK,
5607	NL80211_TDLS_DISABLE_LINK,
5608};
5609
5610/*
5611 * enum nl80211_ap_sme_features - device-integrated AP features
5612 * Reserved for future use, no bits are defined in
5613 * NL80211_ATTR_DEVICE_AP_SME yet.
5614enum nl80211_ap_sme_features {
5615};
5616 */
5617
5618/**
5619 * enum nl80211_feature_flags - device/driver features
5620 * @NL80211_FEATURE_SK_TX_STATUS: This driver supports reflecting back
5621 *	TX status to the socket error queue when requested with the
5622 *	socket option.
5623 * @NL80211_FEATURE_HT_IBSS: This driver supports IBSS with HT datarates.
5624 * @NL80211_FEATURE_INACTIVITY_TIMER: This driver takes care of freeing up
5625 *	the connected inactive stations in AP mode.
5626 * @NL80211_FEATURE_CELL_BASE_REG_HINTS: This driver has been tested
5627 *	to work properly to suppport receiving regulatory hints from
5628 *	cellular base stations.
5629 * @NL80211_FEATURE_P2P_DEVICE_NEEDS_CHANNEL: (no longer available, only
5630 *	here to reserve the value for API/ABI compatibility)
5631 * @NL80211_FEATURE_SAE: This driver supports simultaneous authentication of
5632 *	equals (SAE) with user space SME (NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE) in station
5633 *	mode
5634 * @NL80211_FEATURE_LOW_PRIORITY_SCAN: This driver supports low priority scan
5635 * @NL80211_FEATURE_SCAN_FLUSH: Scan flush is supported
5636 * @NL80211_FEATURE_AP_SCAN: Support scanning using an AP vif
5637 * @NL80211_FEATURE_VIF_TXPOWER: The driver supports per-vif TX power setting
5638 * @NL80211_FEATURE_NEED_OBSS_SCAN: The driver expects userspace to perform
5639 *	OBSS scans and generate 20/40 BSS coex reports. This flag is used only
5640 *	for drivers implementing the CONNECT API, for AUTH/ASSOC it is implied.
5641 * @NL80211_FEATURE_P2P_GO_CTWIN: P2P GO implementation supports CT Window
5642 *	setting
5643 * @NL80211_FEATURE_P2P_GO_OPPPS: P2P GO implementation supports opportunistic
5644 *	powersave
5645 * @NL80211_FEATURE_FULL_AP_CLIENT_STATE: The driver supports full state
5646 *	transitions for AP clients. Without this flag (and if the driver
5647 *	doesn't have the AP SME in the device) the driver supports adding
5648 *	stations only when they're associated and adds them in associated
5649 *	state (to later be transitioned into authorized), with this flag
5650 *	they should be added before even sending the authentication reply
5651 *	and then transitioned into authenticated, associated and authorized
5652 *	states using station flags.
5653 *	Note that even for drivers that support this, the default is to add
5654 *	stations in authenticated/associated state, so to add unauthenticated
5655 *	stations the authenticated/associated bits have to be set in the mask.
5656 * @NL80211_FEATURE_ADVERTISE_CHAN_LIMITS: cfg80211 advertises channel limits
5657 *	(HT40, VHT 80/160 MHz) if this flag is set
5658 * @NL80211_FEATURE_USERSPACE_MPM: This driver supports a userspace Mesh
5659 *	Peering Management entity which may be implemented by registering for
5660 *	beacons or NL80211_CMD_NEW_PEER_CANDIDATE events. The mesh beacon is
5661 *	still generated by the driver.
5662 * @NL80211_FEATURE_ACTIVE_MONITOR: This driver supports an active monitor
5663 *	interface. An active monitor interface behaves like a normal monitor
5664 *	interface, but gets added to the driver. It ensures that incoming
5665 *	unicast packets directed at the configured interface address get ACKed.
5666 * @NL80211_FEATURE_AP_MODE_CHAN_WIDTH_CHANGE: This driver supports dynamic
5667 *	channel bandwidth change (e.g., HT 20 <-> 40 MHz channel) during the
5668 *	lifetime of a BSS.
5669 * @NL80211_FEATURE_DS_PARAM_SET_IE_IN_PROBES: This device adds a DS Parameter
5670 *	Set IE to probe requests.
5671 * @NL80211_FEATURE_WFA_TPC_IE_IN_PROBES: This device adds a WFA TPC Report IE
5672 *	to probe requests.
5673 * @NL80211_FEATURE_QUIET: This device, in client mode, supports Quiet Period
5674 *	requests sent to it by an AP.
5675 * @NL80211_FEATURE_TX_POWER_INSERTION: This device is capable of inserting the
5676 *	current tx power value into the TPC Report IE in the spectrum
5677 *	management TPC Report action frame, and in the Radio Measurement Link
5678 *	Measurement Report action frame.
5679 * @NL80211_FEATURE_ACKTO_ESTIMATION: This driver supports dynamic ACK timeout
5680 *	estimation (dynack). %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_DYN_ACK flag attribute is used
5681 *	to enable dynack.
5682 * @NL80211_FEATURE_STATIC_SMPS: Device supports static spatial
5683 *	multiplexing powersave, ie. can turn off all but one chain
5684 *	even on HT connections that should be using more chains.
5685 * @NL80211_FEATURE_DYNAMIC_SMPS: Device supports dynamic spatial
5686 *	multiplexing powersave, ie. can turn off all but one chain
5687 *	and then wake the rest up as required after, for example,
5688 *	rts/cts handshake.
5689 * @NL80211_FEATURE_SUPPORTS_WMM_ADMISSION: the device supports setting up WMM
5690 *	TSPEC sessions (TID aka TSID 0-7) with the %NL80211_CMD_ADD_TX_TS
5691 *	command. Standard IEEE 802.11 TSPEC setup is not yet supported, it
5692 *	needs to be able to handle Block-Ack agreements and other things.
5693 * @NL80211_FEATURE_MAC_ON_CREATE: Device supports configuring
5694 *	the vif's MAC address upon creation.
5695 *	See 'macaddr' field in the vif_params (cfg80211.h).
5696 * @NL80211_FEATURE_TDLS_CHANNEL_SWITCH: Driver supports channel switching when
5697 *	operating as a TDLS peer.
5698 * @NL80211_FEATURE_SCAN_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR: This device/driver supports using a
5699 *	random MAC address during scan (if the device is unassociated); the
5700 *	%NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_ADDR flag may be set for scans and the MAC
5701 *	address mask/value will be used.
5702 * @NL80211_FEATURE_SCHED_SCAN_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR: This device/driver supports
5703 *	using a random MAC address for every scan iteration during scheduled
5704 *	scan (while not associated), the %NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_ADDR may
5705 *	be set for scheduled scan and the MAC address mask/value will be used.
5706 * @NL80211_FEATURE_ND_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR: This device/driver supports using a
5707 *	random MAC address for every scan iteration during "net detect", i.e.
5708 *	scan in unassociated WoWLAN, the %NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_ADDR may
5709 *	be set for scheduled scan and the MAC address mask/value will be used.
5710 */
5711enum nl80211_feature_flags {
5712	NL80211_FEATURE_SK_TX_STATUS			= 1 << 0,
5713	NL80211_FEATURE_HT_IBSS				= 1 << 1,
5714	NL80211_FEATURE_INACTIVITY_TIMER		= 1 << 2,
5715	NL80211_FEATURE_CELL_BASE_REG_HINTS		= 1 << 3,
5716	NL80211_FEATURE_P2P_DEVICE_NEEDS_CHANNEL	= 1 << 4,
5717	NL80211_FEATURE_SAE				= 1 << 5,
5718	NL80211_FEATURE_LOW_PRIORITY_SCAN		= 1 << 6,
5719	NL80211_FEATURE_SCAN_FLUSH			= 1 << 7,
5720	NL80211_FEATURE_AP_SCAN				= 1 << 8,
5721	NL80211_FEATURE_VIF_TXPOWER			= 1 << 9,
5722	NL80211_FEATURE_NEED_OBSS_SCAN			= 1 << 10,
5723	NL80211_FEATURE_P2P_GO_CTWIN			= 1 << 11,
5724	NL80211_FEATURE_P2P_GO_OPPPS			= 1 << 12,
5725	/* bit 13 is reserved */
5726	NL80211_FEATURE_ADVERTISE_CHAN_LIMITS		= 1 << 14,
5727	NL80211_FEATURE_FULL_AP_CLIENT_STATE		= 1 << 15,
5728	NL80211_FEATURE_USERSPACE_MPM			= 1 << 16,
5729	NL80211_FEATURE_ACTIVE_MONITOR			= 1 << 17,
5730	NL80211_FEATURE_AP_MODE_CHAN_WIDTH_CHANGE	= 1 << 18,
5731	NL80211_FEATURE_DS_PARAM_SET_IE_IN_PROBES	= 1 << 19,
5732	NL80211_FEATURE_WFA_TPC_IE_IN_PROBES		= 1 << 20,
5733	NL80211_FEATURE_QUIET				= 1 << 21,
5734	NL80211_FEATURE_TX_POWER_INSERTION		= 1 << 22,
5735	NL80211_FEATURE_ACKTO_ESTIMATION		= 1 << 23,
5736	NL80211_FEATURE_STATIC_SMPS			= 1 << 24,
5737	NL80211_FEATURE_DYNAMIC_SMPS			= 1 << 25,
5738	NL80211_FEATURE_SUPPORTS_WMM_ADMISSION		= 1 << 26,
5739	NL80211_FEATURE_MAC_ON_CREATE			= 1 << 27,
5740	NL80211_FEATURE_TDLS_CHANNEL_SWITCH		= 1 << 28,
5741	NL80211_FEATURE_SCAN_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR		= 1 << 29,
5742	NL80211_FEATURE_SCHED_SCAN_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR	= 1 << 30,
5743	NL80211_FEATURE_ND_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR		= 1U << 31,
5744};
5745
5746/**
5747 * enum nl80211_ext_feature_index - bit index of extended features.
5748 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_VHT_IBSS: This driver supports IBSS with VHT datarates.
5749 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_RRM: This driver supports RRM. When featured, user can
5750 *	request to use RRM (see %NL80211_ATTR_USE_RRM) with
5751 *	%NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE and %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT requests, which will set
5752 *	the ASSOC_REQ_USE_RRM flag in the association request even if
5753 *	NL80211_FEATURE_QUIET is not advertized.
5754 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MU_MIMO_AIR_SNIFFER: This device supports MU-MIMO air
5755 *	sniffer which means that it can be configured to hear packets from
5756 *	certain groups which can be configured by the
5757 *	%NL80211_ATTR_MU_MIMO_GROUP_DATA attribute,
5758 *	or can be configured to follow a station by configuring the
5759 *	%NL80211_ATTR_MU_MIMO_FOLLOW_MAC_ADDR attribute.
5760 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCAN_START_TIME: This driver includes the actual
5761 *	time the scan started in scan results event. The time is the TSF of
5762 *	the BSS that the interface that requested the scan is connected to
5763 *	(if available).
5764 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BSS_PARENT_TSF: Per BSS, this driver reports the
5765 *	time the last beacon/probe was received. The time is the TSF of the
5766 *	BSS that the interface that requested the scan is connected to
5767 *	(if available).
5768 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SET_SCAN_DWELL: This driver supports configuration of
5769 *	channel dwell time.
5770 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_LEGACY: Driver supports beacon rate
5771 *	configuration (AP/mesh), supporting a legacy (non HT/VHT) rate.
5772 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_HT: Driver supports beacon rate
5773 *	configuration (AP/mesh) with HT rates.
5774 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_VHT: Driver supports beacon rate
5775 *	configuration (AP/mesh) with VHT rates.
5776 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_STA: This driver supports Fast Initial Link Setup
5777 *	with user space SME (NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE) in station mode.
5778 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MGMT_TX_RANDOM_TA: This driver supports randomized TA
5779 *	in @NL80211_CMD_FRAME while not associated.
5780 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MGMT_TX_RANDOM_TA_CONNECTED: This driver supports
5781 *	randomized TA in @NL80211_CMD_FRAME while associated.
5782 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCHED_SCAN_RELATIVE_RSSI: The driver supports sched_scan
5783 *	for reporting BSSs with better RSSI than the current connected BSS
5784 *	(%NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_RELATIVE_RSSI).
5785 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CQM_RSSI_LIST: With this driver the
5786 *	%NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_THOLD attribute accepts a list of zero or more
5787 *	RSSI threshold values to monitor rather than exactly one threshold.
5788 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_SK_OFFLOAD: Driver SME supports FILS shared key
5789 *	authentication with %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT.
5790 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_STA_PSK: Device wants to do 4-way
5791 *	handshake with PSK in station mode (PSK is passed as part of the connect
5792 *	and associate commands), doing it in the host might not be supported.
5793 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_STA_1X: Device wants to do doing 4-way
5794 *	handshake with 802.1X in station mode (will pass EAP frames to the host
5795 *	and accept the set_pmk/del_pmk commands), doing it in the host might not
5796 *	be supported.
5797 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_MAX_CHANNEL_TIME: Driver is capable of overriding
5798 *	the max channel attribute in the FILS request params IE with the
5799 *	actual dwell time.
5800 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_ACCEPT_BCAST_PROBE_RESP: Driver accepts broadcast probe
5801 *	response
5802 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OCE_PROBE_REQ_HIGH_TX_RATE: Driver supports sending
5803 *	the first probe request in each channel at rate of at least 5.5Mbps.
5804 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OCE_PROBE_REQ_DEFERRAL_SUPPRESSION: Driver supports
5805 *	probe request tx deferral and suppression
5806 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MFP_OPTIONAL: Driver supports the %NL80211_MFP_OPTIONAL
5807 *	value in %NL80211_ATTR_USE_MFP.
5808 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_LOW_SPAN_SCAN: Driver supports low span scan.
5809 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_LOW_POWER_SCAN: Driver supports low power scan.
5810 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_HIGH_ACCURACY_SCAN: Driver supports high accuracy scan.
5811 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_DFS_OFFLOAD: HW/driver will offload DFS actions.
5812 *	Device or driver will do all DFS-related actions by itself,
5813 *	informing user-space about CAC progress, radar detection event,
5814 *	channel change triggered by radar detection event.
5815 *	No need to start CAC from user-space, no need to react to
5816 *	"radar detected" event.
5817 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CONTROL_PORT_OVER_NL80211: Driver supports sending and
5818 *	receiving control port frames over nl80211 instead of the netdevice.
5819 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_ACK_SIGNAL_SUPPORT: This driver/device supports
5820 *	(average) ACK signal strength reporting.
5821 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_TXQS: Driver supports FQ-CoDel-enabled intermediate
5822 *      TXQs.
5823 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCAN_RANDOM_SN: Driver/device supports randomizing the
5824 *	SN in probe request frames if requested by %NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_SN.
5825 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCAN_MIN_PREQ_CONTENT: Driver/device can omit all data
5826 *	except for supported rates from the probe request content if requested
5827 *	by the %NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_MIN_PREQ_CONTENT flag.
5828 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_ENABLE_FTM_RESPONDER: Driver supports enabling fine
5829 *	timing measurement responder role.
5830 *
5831 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CAN_REPLACE_PTK0: Driver/device confirm that they are
5832 *      able to rekey an in-use key correctly. Userspace must not rekey PTK keys
5833 *      if this flag is not set. Ignoring this can leak clear text packets and/or
5834 *      freeze the connection.
5835 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_EXT_KEY_ID: Driver supports "Extended Key ID for
5836 *      Individually Addressed Frames" from IEEE802.11-2016.
5837 *
5838 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_AIRTIME_FAIRNESS: Driver supports getting airtime
5839 *	fairness for transmitted packets and has enabled airtime fairness
5840 *	scheduling.
5841 *
5842 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_AP_PMKSA_CACHING: Driver/device supports PMKSA caching
5843 *	(set/del PMKSA operations) in AP mode.
5844 *
5845 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCHED_SCAN_BAND_SPECIFIC_RSSI_THOLD: Driver supports
5846 *	filtering of sched scan results using band specific RSSI thresholds.
5847 *
5848 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_STA_TX_PWR: This driver supports controlling tx power
5849 *	to a station.
5850 *
5851 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SAE_OFFLOAD: Device wants to do SAE authentication in
5852 *	station mode (SAE password is passed as part of the connect command).
5853 *
5854 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_VLAN_OFFLOAD: The driver supports a single netdev
5855 *	with VLAN tagged frames and separate VLAN-specific netdevs added using
5856 *	vconfig similarly to the Ethernet case.
5857 *
5858 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_AQL: The driver supports the Airtime Queue Limit (AQL)
5859 *	feature, which prevents bufferbloat by using the expected transmission
5860 *	time to limit the amount of data buffered in the hardware.
5861 *
5862 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_PROTECTION: The driver supports Beacon protection
5863 *	and can receive key configuration for BIGTK using key indexes 6 and 7.
5864 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_PROTECTION_CLIENT: The driver supports Beacon
5865 *	protection as a client only and cannot transmit protected beacons.
5866 *
5867 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CONTROL_PORT_NO_PREAUTH: The driver can disable the
5868 *	forwarding of preauth frames over the control port. They are then
5869 *	handled as ordinary data frames.
5870 *
5871 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_PROTECTED_TWT: Driver supports protected TWT frames
5872 *
5873 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_DEL_IBSS_STA: The driver supports removing stations
5874 *      in IBSS mode, essentially by dropping their state.
5875 *
5876 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MULTICAST_REGISTRATIONS: management frame registrations
5877 *	are possible for multicast frames and those will be reported properly.
5878 *
5879 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCAN_FREQ_KHZ: This driver supports receiving and
5880 *	reporting scan request with %NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQ_KHZ. In order to
5881 *	report %NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQ_KHZ, %NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_FREQ_KHZ must be
5882 *	included in the scan request.
5883 *
5884 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CONTROL_PORT_OVER_NL80211_TX_STATUS: The driver
5885 *	can report tx status for control port over nl80211 tx operations.
5886 *
5887 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OPERATING_CHANNEL_VALIDATION: Driver supports Operating
5888 *	Channel Validation (OCV) when using driver's SME for RSNA handshakes.
5889 *
5890 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_AP_PSK: Device wants to do 4-way
5891 *	handshake with PSK in AP mode (PSK is passed as part of the start AP
5892 *	command).
5893 *
5894 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SAE_OFFLOAD_AP: Device wants to do SAE authentication
5895 *	in AP mode (SAE password is passed as part of the start AP command).
5896 *
5897 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_DISCOVERY: Driver/device supports FILS discovery
5898 *	frames transmission
5899 *
5900 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP: Driver/device supports
5901 *	unsolicited broadcast probe response transmission
5902 *
5903 * @NUM_NL80211_EXT_FEATURES: number of extended features.
5904 * @MAX_NL80211_EXT_FEATURES: highest extended feature index.
5905 */
5906enum nl80211_ext_feature_index {
5907	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_VHT_IBSS,
5908	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_RRM,
5909	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MU_MIMO_AIR_SNIFFER,
5910	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCAN_START_TIME,
5911	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BSS_PARENT_TSF,
5912	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SET_SCAN_DWELL,
5913	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_LEGACY,
5914	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_HT,
5915	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_VHT,
5916	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_STA,
5917	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MGMT_TX_RANDOM_TA,
5918	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MGMT_TX_RANDOM_TA_CONNECTED,
5919	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCHED_SCAN_RELATIVE_RSSI,
5920	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CQM_RSSI_LIST,
5921	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_SK_OFFLOAD,
5922	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_STA_PSK,
5923	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_STA_1X,
5924	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_MAX_CHANNEL_TIME,
5925	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_ACCEPT_BCAST_PROBE_RESP,
5926	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OCE_PROBE_REQ_HIGH_TX_RATE,
5927	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OCE_PROBE_REQ_DEFERRAL_SUPPRESSION,
5928	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MFP_OPTIONAL,
5929	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_LOW_SPAN_SCAN,
5930	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_LOW_POWER_SCAN,
5931	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_HIGH_ACCURACY_SCAN,
5932	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_DFS_OFFLOAD,
5933	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CONTROL_PORT_OVER_NL80211,
5934	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_ACK_SIGNAL_SUPPORT,
5935	/* we renamed this - stay compatible */
5936	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_DATA_ACK_SIGNAL_SUPPORT = NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_ACK_SIGNAL_SUPPORT,
5937	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_TXQS,
5938	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCAN_RANDOM_SN,
5939	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCAN_MIN_PREQ_CONTENT,
5940	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CAN_REPLACE_PTK0,
5941	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_ENABLE_FTM_RESPONDER,
5942	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_AIRTIME_FAIRNESS,
5943	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_AP_PMKSA_CACHING,
5944	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCHED_SCAN_BAND_SPECIFIC_RSSI_THOLD,
5945	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_EXT_KEY_ID,
5946	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_STA_TX_PWR,
5947	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SAE_OFFLOAD,
5948	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_VLAN_OFFLOAD,
5949	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_AQL,
5950	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_PROTECTION,
5951	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CONTROL_PORT_NO_PREAUTH,
5952	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_PROTECTED_TWT,
5953	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_DEL_IBSS_STA,
5954	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MULTICAST_REGISTRATIONS,
5955	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_PROTECTION_CLIENT,
5956	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCAN_FREQ_KHZ,
5957	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CONTROL_PORT_OVER_NL80211_TX_STATUS,
5958	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OPERATING_CHANNEL_VALIDATION,
5959	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_AP_PSK,
5960	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SAE_OFFLOAD_AP,
5961	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_DISCOVERY,
5962	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP,
5963
5964	/* add new features before the definition below */
5965	NUM_NL80211_EXT_FEATURES,
5966	MAX_NL80211_EXT_FEATURES = NUM_NL80211_EXT_FEATURES - 1
5967};
5968
5969/**
5970 * enum nl80211_probe_resp_offload_support_attr - optional supported
5971 *	protocols for probe-response offloading by the driver/FW.
5972 *	To be used with the %NL80211_ATTR_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD attribute.
5973 *	Each enum value represents a bit in the bitmap of supported
5974 *	protocols. Typically a subset of probe-requests belonging to a
5975 *	supported protocol will be excluded from offload and uploaded
5976 *	to the host.
5977 *
5978 * @NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_WPS: Support for WPS ver. 1
5979 * @NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_WPS2: Support for WPS ver. 2
5980 * @NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_P2P: Support for P2P
5981 * @NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_80211U: Support for 802.11u
5982 */
5983enum nl80211_probe_resp_offload_support_attr {
5984	NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_WPS =	1<<0,
5985	NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_WPS2 =	1<<1,
5986	NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_P2P =	1<<2,
5987	NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_80211U =	1<<3,
5988};
5989
5990/**
5991 * enum nl80211_connect_failed_reason - connection request failed reasons
5992 * @NL80211_CONN_FAIL_MAX_CLIENTS: Maximum number of clients that can be
5993 *	handled by the AP is reached.
5994 * @NL80211_CONN_FAIL_BLOCKED_CLIENT: Connection request is rejected due to ACL.
5995 */
5996enum nl80211_connect_failed_reason {
5997	NL80211_CONN_FAIL_MAX_CLIENTS,
5998	NL80211_CONN_FAIL_BLOCKED_CLIENT,
5999};
6000
6001/**
6002 * enum nl80211_timeout_reason - timeout reasons
6003 *
6004 * @NL80211_TIMEOUT_UNSPECIFIED: Timeout reason unspecified.
6005 * @NL80211_TIMEOUT_SCAN: Scan (AP discovery) timed out.
6006 * @NL80211_TIMEOUT_AUTH: Authentication timed out.
6007 * @NL80211_TIMEOUT_ASSOC: Association timed out.
6008 */
6009enum nl80211_timeout_reason {
6010	NL80211_TIMEOUT_UNSPECIFIED,
6011	NL80211_TIMEOUT_SCAN,
6012	NL80211_TIMEOUT_AUTH,
6013	NL80211_TIMEOUT_ASSOC,
6014};
6015
6016/**
6017 * enum nl80211_scan_flags -  scan request control flags
6018 *
6019 * Scan request control flags are used to control the handling
6020 * of NL80211_CMD_TRIGGER_SCAN and NL80211_CMD_START_SCHED_SCAN
6021 * requests.
6022 *
6023 * NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_SPAN, NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_POWER, and
6024 * NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_HIGH_ACCURACY flags are exclusive of each other, i.e., only
6025 * one of them can be used in the request.
6026 *
6027 * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_PRIORITY: scan request has low priority
6028 * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_FLUSH: flush cache before scanning
6029 * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_AP: force a scan even if the interface is configured
6030 *	as AP and the beaconing has already been configured. This attribute is
6031 *	dangerous because will destroy stations performance as a lot of frames
6032 *	will be lost while scanning off-channel, therefore it must be used only
6033 *	when really needed
6034 * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_ADDR: use a random MAC address for this scan (or
6035 *	for scheduled scan: a different one for every scan iteration). When the
6036 *	flag is set, depending on device capabilities the @NL80211_ATTR_MAC and
6037 *	@NL80211_ATTR_MAC_MASK attributes may also be given in which case only
6038 *	the masked bits will be preserved from the MAC address and the remainder
6039 *	randomised. If the attributes are not given full randomisation (46 bits,
6040 *	locally administered 1, multicast 0) is assumed.
6041 *	This flag must not be requested when the feature isn't supported, check
6042 *	the nl80211 feature flags for the device.
6043 * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_FILS_MAX_CHANNEL_TIME: fill the dwell time in the FILS
6044 *	request parameters IE in the probe request
6045 * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_ACCEPT_BCAST_PROBE_RESP: accept broadcast probe responses
6046 * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_OCE_PROBE_REQ_HIGH_TX_RATE: send probe request frames at
6047 *	rate of at least 5.5M. In case non OCE AP is discovered in the channel,
6048 *	only the first probe req in the channel will be sent in high rate.
6049 * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_OCE_PROBE_REQ_DEFERRAL_SUPPRESSION: allow probe request
6050 *	tx deferral (dot11FILSProbeDelay shall be set to 15ms)
6051 *	and suppression (if it has received a broadcast Probe Response frame,
6052 *	Beacon frame or FILS Discovery frame from an AP that the STA considers
6053 *	a suitable candidate for (re-)association - suitable in terms of
6054 *	SSID and/or RSSI.
6055 * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_SPAN: Span corresponds to the total time taken to
6056 *	accomplish the scan. Thus, this flag intends the driver to perform the
6057 *	scan request with lesser span/duration. It is specific to the driver
6058 *	implementations on how this is accomplished. Scan accuracy may get
6059 *	impacted with this flag.
6060 * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_POWER: This flag intends the scan attempts to consume
6061 *	optimal possible power. Drivers can resort to their specific means to
6062 *	optimize the power. Scan accuracy may get impacted with this flag.
6063 * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_HIGH_ACCURACY: Accuracy here intends to the extent of scan
6064 *	results obtained. Thus HIGH_ACCURACY scan flag aims to get maximum
6065 *	possible scan results. This flag hints the driver to use the best
6066 *	possible scan configuration to improve the accuracy in scanning.
6067 *	Latency and power use may get impacted with this flag.
6068 * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_SN: randomize the sequence number in probe
6069 *	request frames from this scan to avoid correlation/tracking being
6070 *	possible.
6071 * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_MIN_PREQ_CONTENT: minimize probe request content to
6072 *	only have supported rates and no additional capabilities (unless
6073 *	added by userspace explicitly.)
6074 * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_FREQ_KHZ: report scan results with
6075 *	%NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQ_KHZ. This also means
6076 *	%NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQUENCIES will not be included.
6077 * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_COLOCATED_6GHZ: scan for colocated APs reported by
6078 *	2.4/5 GHz APs
6079 */
6080enum nl80211_scan_flags {
6081	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_PRIORITY				= 1<<0,
6082	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_FLUSH					= 1<<1,
6083	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_AP					= 1<<2,
6084	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_ADDR				= 1<<3,
6085	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_FILS_MAX_CHANNEL_TIME			= 1<<4,
6086	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_ACCEPT_BCAST_PROBE_RESP		= 1<<5,
6087	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_OCE_PROBE_REQ_HIGH_TX_RATE		= 1<<6,
6088	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_OCE_PROBE_REQ_DEFERRAL_SUPPRESSION	= 1<<7,
6089	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_SPAN				= 1<<8,
6090	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_POWER				= 1<<9,
6091	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_HIGH_ACCURACY				= 1<<10,
6092	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_SN				= 1<<11,
6093	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_MIN_PREQ_CONTENT			= 1<<12,
6094	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_FREQ_KHZ				= 1<<13,
6095	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_COLOCATED_6GHZ			= 1<<14,
6096};
6097
6098/**
6099 * enum nl80211_acl_policy - access control policy
6100 *
6101 * Access control policy is applied on a MAC list set by
6102 * %NL80211_CMD_START_AP and %NL80211_CMD_SET_MAC_ACL, to
6103 * be used with %NL80211_ATTR_ACL_POLICY.
6104 *
6105 * @NL80211_ACL_POLICY_ACCEPT_UNLESS_LISTED: Deny stations which are
6106 *	listed in ACL, i.e. allow all the stations which are not listed
6107 *	in ACL to authenticate.
6108 * @NL80211_ACL_POLICY_DENY_UNLESS_LISTED: Allow the stations which are listed
6109 *	in ACL, i.e. deny all the stations which are not listed in ACL.
6110 */
6111enum nl80211_acl_policy {
6112	NL80211_ACL_POLICY_ACCEPT_UNLESS_LISTED,
6113	NL80211_ACL_POLICY_DENY_UNLESS_LISTED,
6114};
6115
6116/**
6117 * enum nl80211_smps_mode - SMPS mode
6118 *
6119 * Requested SMPS mode (for AP mode)
6120 *
6121 * @NL80211_SMPS_OFF: SMPS off (use all antennas).
6122 * @NL80211_SMPS_STATIC: static SMPS (use a single antenna)
6123 * @NL80211_SMPS_DYNAMIC: dynamic smps (start with a single antenna and
6124 *	turn on other antennas after CTS/RTS).
6125 */
6126enum nl80211_smps_mode {
6127	NL80211_SMPS_OFF,
6128	NL80211_SMPS_STATIC,
6129	NL80211_SMPS_DYNAMIC,
6130
6131	__NL80211_SMPS_AFTER_LAST,
6132	NL80211_SMPS_MAX = __NL80211_SMPS_AFTER_LAST - 1
6133};
6134
6135/**
6136 * enum nl80211_radar_event - type of radar event for DFS operation
6137 *
6138 * Type of event to be used with NL80211_ATTR_RADAR_EVENT to inform userspace
6139 * about detected radars or success of the channel available check (CAC)
6140 *
6141 * @NL80211_RADAR_DETECTED: A radar pattern has been detected. The channel is
6142 *	now unusable.
6143 * @NL80211_RADAR_CAC_FINISHED: Channel Availability Check has been finished,
6144 *	the channel is now available.
6145 * @NL80211_RADAR_CAC_ABORTED: Channel Availability Check has been aborted, no
6146 *	change to the channel status.
6147 * @NL80211_RADAR_NOP_FINISHED: The Non-Occupancy Period for this channel is
6148 *	over, channel becomes usable.
6149 * @NL80211_RADAR_PRE_CAC_EXPIRED: Channel Availability Check done on this
6150 *	non-operating channel is expired and no longer valid. New CAC must
6151 *	be done on this channel before starting the operation. This is not
6152 *	applicable for ETSI dfs domain where pre-CAC is valid for ever.
6153 * @NL80211_RADAR_CAC_STARTED: Channel Availability Check has been started,
6154 *	should be generated by HW if NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_DFS_OFFLOAD is enabled.
6155 */
6156enum nl80211_radar_event {
6157	NL80211_RADAR_DETECTED,
6158	NL80211_RADAR_CAC_FINISHED,
6159	NL80211_RADAR_CAC_ABORTED,
6160	NL80211_RADAR_NOP_FINISHED,
6161	NL80211_RADAR_PRE_CAC_EXPIRED,
6162	NL80211_RADAR_CAC_STARTED,
6163};
6164
6165/**
6166 * enum nl80211_dfs_state - DFS states for channels
6167 *
6168 * Channel states used by the DFS code.
6169 *
6170 * @NL80211_DFS_USABLE: The channel can be used, but channel availability
6171 *	check (CAC) must be performed before using it for AP or IBSS.
6172 * @NL80211_DFS_UNAVAILABLE: A radar has been detected on this channel, it
6173 *	is therefore marked as not available.
6174 * @NL80211_DFS_AVAILABLE: The channel has been CAC checked and is available.
6175 */
6176enum nl80211_dfs_state {
6177	NL80211_DFS_USABLE,
6178	NL80211_DFS_UNAVAILABLE,
6179	NL80211_DFS_AVAILABLE,
6180};
6181
6182/**
6183 * enum nl80211_protocol_features - nl80211 protocol features
6184 * @NL80211_PROTOCOL_FEATURE_SPLIT_WIPHY_DUMP: nl80211 supports splitting
6185 *	wiphy dumps (if requested by the application with the attribute
6186 *	%NL80211_ATTR_SPLIT_WIPHY_DUMP. Also supported is filtering the
6187 *	wiphy dump by %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY, %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX or
6188 *	%NL80211_ATTR_WDEV.
6189 */
6190enum nl80211_protocol_features {
6191	NL80211_PROTOCOL_FEATURE_SPLIT_WIPHY_DUMP =	1 << 0,
6192};
6193
6194/**
6195 * enum nl80211_crit_proto_id - nl80211 critical protocol identifiers
6196 *
6197 * @NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_UNSPEC: protocol unspecified.
6198 * @NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_DHCP: BOOTP or DHCPv6 protocol.
6199 * @NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_EAPOL: EAPOL protocol.
6200 * @NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_APIPA: APIPA protocol.
6201 * @NUM_NL80211_CRIT_PROTO: must be kept last.
6202 */
6203enum nl80211_crit_proto_id {
6204	NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_UNSPEC,
6205	NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_DHCP,
6206	NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_EAPOL,
6207	NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_APIPA,
6208	/* add other protocols before this one */
6209	NUM_NL80211_CRIT_PROTO
6210};
6211
6212/* maximum duration for critical protocol measures */
6213#define NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_MAX_DURATION		5000 /* msec */
6214
6215/**
6216 * enum nl80211_rxmgmt_flags - flags for received management frame.
6217 *
6218 * Used by cfg80211_rx_mgmt()
6219 *
6220 * @NL80211_RXMGMT_FLAG_ANSWERED: frame was answered by device/driver.
6221 * @NL80211_RXMGMT_FLAG_EXTERNAL_AUTH: Host driver intends to offload
6222 *	the authentication. Exclusively defined for host drivers that
6223 *	advertises the SME functionality but would like the userspace
6224 *	to handle certain authentication algorithms (e.g. SAE).
6225 */
6226enum nl80211_rxmgmt_flags {
6227	NL80211_RXMGMT_FLAG_ANSWERED = 1 << 0,
6228	NL80211_RXMGMT_FLAG_EXTERNAL_AUTH = 1 << 1,
6229};
6230
6231/*
6232 * If this flag is unset, the lower 24 bits are an OUI, if set
6233 * a Linux nl80211 vendor ID is used (no such IDs are allocated
6234 * yet, so that's not valid so far)
6235 */
6236#define NL80211_VENDOR_ID_IS_LINUX	0x80000000
6237
6238/**
6239 * struct nl80211_vendor_cmd_info - vendor command data
6240 * @vendor_id: If the %NL80211_VENDOR_ID_IS_LINUX flag is clear, then the
6241 *	value is a 24-bit OUI; if it is set then a separately allocated ID
6242 *	may be used, but no such IDs are allocated yet. New IDs should be
6243 *	added to this file when needed.
6244 * @subcmd: sub-command ID for the command
6245 */
6246struct nl80211_vendor_cmd_info {
6247	__u32 vendor_id;
6248	__u32 subcmd;
6249};
6250
6251/**
6252 * enum nl80211_tdls_peer_capability - TDLS peer flags.
6253 *
6254 * Used by tdls_mgmt() to determine which conditional elements need
6255 * to be added to TDLS Setup frames.
6256 *
6257 * @NL80211_TDLS_PEER_HT: TDLS peer is HT capable.
6258 * @NL80211_TDLS_PEER_VHT: TDLS peer is VHT capable.
6259 * @NL80211_TDLS_PEER_WMM: TDLS peer is WMM capable.
6260 */
6261enum nl80211_tdls_peer_capability {
6262	NL80211_TDLS_PEER_HT = 1<<0,
6263	NL80211_TDLS_PEER_VHT = 1<<1,
6264	NL80211_TDLS_PEER_WMM = 1<<2,
6265};
6266
6267/**
6268 * enum nl80211_sched_scan_plan - scanning plan for scheduled scan
6269 * @__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
6270 * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_INTERVAL: interval between scan iterations. In
6271 *	seconds (u32).
6272 * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_ITERATIONS: number of scan iterations in this
6273 *	scan plan (u32). The last scan plan must not specify this attribute
6274 *	because it will run infinitely. A value of zero is invalid as it will
6275 *	make the scan plan meaningless.
6276 * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_MAX: highest scheduled scan plan attribute number
6277 *	currently defined
6278 * @__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_AFTER_LAST: internal use
6279 */
6280enum nl80211_sched_scan_plan {
6281	__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_INVALID,
6282	NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_INTERVAL,
6283	NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_ITERATIONS,
6284
6285	/* keep last */
6286	__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_AFTER_LAST,
6287	NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_MAX =
6288		__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_AFTER_LAST - 1
6289};
6290
6291/**
6292 * struct nl80211_bss_select_rssi_adjust - RSSI adjustment parameters.
6293 *
6294 * @band: band of BSS that must match for RSSI value adjustment. The value
6295 *	of this field is according to &enum nl80211_band.
6296 * @delta: value used to adjust the RSSI value of matching BSS in dB.
6297 */
6298struct nl80211_bss_select_rssi_adjust {
6299	__u8 band;
6300	__s8 delta;
6301} __attribute__((packed));
6302
6303/**
6304 * enum nl80211_bss_select_attr - attributes for bss selection.
6305 *
6306 * @__NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_INVALID: reserved.
6307 * @NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_RSSI: Flag indicating only RSSI-based BSS selection
6308 *	is requested.
6309 * @NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_BAND_PREF: attribute indicating BSS
6310 *	selection should be done such that the specified band is preferred.
6311 *	When there are multiple BSS-es in the preferred band, the driver
6312 *	shall use RSSI-based BSS selection as a second step. The value of
6313 *	this attribute is according to &enum nl80211_band (u32).
6314 * @NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_RSSI_ADJUST: When present the RSSI level for
6315 *	BSS-es in the specified band is to be adjusted before doing
6316 *	RSSI-based BSS selection. The attribute value is a packed structure
6317 *	value as specified by &struct nl80211_bss_select_rssi_adjust.
6318 * @NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_MAX: highest bss select attribute number.
6319 * @__NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use.
6320 *
6321 * One and only one of these attributes are found within %NL80211_ATTR_BSS_SELECT
6322 * for %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT. It specifies the required BSS selection behaviour
6323 * which the driver shall use.
6324 */
6325enum nl80211_bss_select_attr {
6326	__NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_INVALID,
6327	NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_RSSI,
6328	NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_BAND_PREF,
6329	NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_RSSI_ADJUST,
6330
6331	/* keep last */
6332	__NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
6333	NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
6334};
6335
6336/**
6337 * enum nl80211_nan_function_type - NAN function type
6338 *
6339 * Defines the function type of a NAN function
6340 *
6341 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH: function is publish
6342 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SUBSCRIBE: function is subscribe
6343 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP: function is follow-up
6344 */
6345enum nl80211_nan_function_type {
6346	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH,
6347	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SUBSCRIBE,
6348	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP,
6349
6350	/* keep last */
6351	__NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TYPE_AFTER_LAST,
6352	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_MAX_TYPE = __NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TYPE_AFTER_LAST - 1,
6353};
6354
6355/**
6356 * enum nl80211_nan_publish_type - NAN publish tx type
6357 *
6358 * Defines how to send publish Service Discovery Frames
6359 *
6360 * @NL80211_NAN_SOLICITED_PUBLISH: publish function is solicited
6361 * @NL80211_NAN_UNSOLICITED_PUBLISH: publish function is unsolicited
6362 */
6363enum nl80211_nan_publish_type {
6364	NL80211_NAN_SOLICITED_PUBLISH = 1 << 0,
6365	NL80211_NAN_UNSOLICITED_PUBLISH = 1 << 1,
6366};
6367
6368/**
6369 * enum nl80211_nan_func_term_reason - NAN functions termination reason
6370 *
6371 * Defines termination reasons of a NAN function
6372 *
6373 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_USER_REQUEST: requested by user
6374 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_TTL_EXPIRED: timeout
6375 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_ERROR: errored
6376 */
6377enum nl80211_nan_func_term_reason {
6378	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_USER_REQUEST,
6379	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_TTL_EXPIRED,
6380	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_ERROR,
6381};
6382
6383#define NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_ID_LEN 6
6384#define NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_SPEC_INFO_MAX_LEN 0xff
6385#define NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SRF_MAX_LEN 0xff
6386
6387/**
6388 * enum nl80211_nan_func_attributes - NAN function attributes
6389 * @__NL80211_NAN_FUNC_INVALID: invalid
6390 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TYPE: &enum nl80211_nan_function_type (u8).
6391 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_ID: 6 bytes of the service ID hash as
6392 *	specified in NAN spec. This is a binary attribute.
6393 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH_TYPE: relevant if the function's type is
6394 *	publish. Defines the transmission type for the publish Service Discovery
6395 *	Frame, see &enum nl80211_nan_publish_type. Its type is u8.
6396 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH_BCAST: relevant if the function is a solicited
6397 *	publish. Should the solicited publish Service Discovery Frame be sent to
6398 *	the NAN Broadcast address. This is a flag.
6399 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SUBSCRIBE_ACTIVE: relevant if the function's type is
6400 *	subscribe. Is the subscribe active. This is a flag.
6401 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP_ID: relevant if the function's type is follow up.
6402 *	The instance ID for the follow up Service Discovery Frame. This is u8.
6403 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP_REQ_ID: relevant if the function's type
6404 *	is follow up. This is a u8.
6405 *	The requestor instance ID for the follow up Service Discovery Frame.
6406 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP_DEST: the MAC address of the recipient of the
6407 *	follow up Service Discovery Frame. This is a binary attribute.
6408 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_CLOSE_RANGE: is this function limited for devices in a
6409 *	close range. The range itself (RSSI) is defined by the device.
6410 *	This is a flag.
6411 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TTL: strictly positive number of DWs this function should
6412 *	stay active. If not present infinite TTL is assumed. This is a u32.
6413 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_INFO: array of bytes describing the service
6414 *	specific info. This is a binary attribute.
6415 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SRF: Service Receive Filter. This is a nested attribute.
6416 *	See &enum nl80211_nan_srf_attributes.
6417 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_RX_MATCH_FILTER: Receive Matching filter. This is a nested
6418 *	attribute. It is a list of binary values.
6419 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TX_MATCH_FILTER: Transmit Matching filter. This is a
6420 *	nested attribute. It is a list of binary values.
6421 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_INSTANCE_ID: The instance ID of the function.
6422 *	Its type is u8 and it cannot be 0.
6423 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON: NAN function termination reason.
6424 *	See &enum nl80211_nan_func_term_reason.
6425 *
6426 * @NUM_NL80211_NAN_FUNC_ATTR: internal
6427 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_ATTR_MAX: highest NAN function attribute
6428 */
6429enum nl80211_nan_func_attributes {
6430	__NL80211_NAN_FUNC_INVALID,
6431	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TYPE,
6432	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_ID,
6433	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH_TYPE,
6434	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH_BCAST,
6435	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SUBSCRIBE_ACTIVE,
6436	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP_ID,
6437	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP_REQ_ID,
6438	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP_DEST,
6439	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_CLOSE_RANGE,
6440	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TTL,
6441	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_INFO,
6442	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SRF,
6443	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_RX_MATCH_FILTER,
6444	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TX_MATCH_FILTER,
6445	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_INSTANCE_ID,
6446	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON,
6447
6448	/* keep last */
6449	NUM_NL80211_NAN_FUNC_ATTR,
6450	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_NAN_FUNC_ATTR - 1
6451};
6452
6453/**
6454 * enum nl80211_nan_srf_attributes - NAN Service Response filter attributes
6455 * @__NL80211_NAN_SRF_INVALID: invalid
6456 * @NL80211_NAN_SRF_INCLUDE: present if the include bit of the SRF set.
6457 *	This is a flag.
6458 * @NL80211_NAN_SRF_BF: Bloom Filter. Present if and only if
6459 *	%NL80211_NAN_SRF_MAC_ADDRS isn't present. This attribute is binary.
6460 * @NL80211_NAN_SRF_BF_IDX: index of the Bloom Filter. Mandatory if
6461 *	%NL80211_NAN_SRF_BF is present. This is a u8.
6462 * @NL80211_NAN_SRF_MAC_ADDRS: list of MAC addresses for the SRF. Present if
6463 *	and only if %NL80211_NAN_SRF_BF isn't present. This is a nested
6464 *	attribute. Each nested attribute is a MAC address.
6465 * @NUM_NL80211_NAN_SRF_ATTR: internal
6466 * @NL80211_NAN_SRF_ATTR_MAX: highest NAN SRF attribute
6467 */
6468enum nl80211_nan_srf_attributes {
6469	__NL80211_NAN_SRF_INVALID,
6470	NL80211_NAN_SRF_INCLUDE,
6471	NL80211_NAN_SRF_BF,
6472	NL80211_NAN_SRF_BF_IDX,
6473	NL80211_NAN_SRF_MAC_ADDRS,
6474
6475	/* keep last */
6476	NUM_NL80211_NAN_SRF_ATTR,
6477	NL80211_NAN_SRF_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_NAN_SRF_ATTR - 1,
6478};
6479
6480/**
6481 * enum nl80211_nan_match_attributes - NAN match attributes
6482 * @__NL80211_NAN_MATCH_INVALID: invalid
6483 * @NL80211_NAN_MATCH_FUNC_LOCAL: the local function that had the
6484 *	match. This is a nested attribute.
6485 *	See &enum nl80211_nan_func_attributes.
6486 * @NL80211_NAN_MATCH_FUNC_PEER: the peer function
6487 *	that caused the match. This is a nested attribute.
6488 *	See &enum nl80211_nan_func_attributes.
6489 *
6490 * @NUM_NL80211_NAN_MATCH_ATTR: internal
6491 * @NL80211_NAN_MATCH_ATTR_MAX: highest NAN match attribute
6492 */
6493enum nl80211_nan_match_attributes {
6494	__NL80211_NAN_MATCH_INVALID,
6495	NL80211_NAN_MATCH_FUNC_LOCAL,
6496	NL80211_NAN_MATCH_FUNC_PEER,
6497
6498	/* keep last */
6499	NUM_NL80211_NAN_MATCH_ATTR,
6500	NL80211_NAN_MATCH_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_NAN_MATCH_ATTR - 1
6501};
6502
6503/**
6504 * nl80211_external_auth_action - Action to perform with external
6505 *     authentication request. Used by NL80211_ATTR_EXTERNAL_AUTH_ACTION.
6506 * @NL80211_EXTERNAL_AUTH_START: Start the authentication.
6507 * @NL80211_EXTERNAL_AUTH_ABORT: Abort the ongoing authentication.
6508 */
6509enum nl80211_external_auth_action {
6510	NL80211_EXTERNAL_AUTH_START,
6511	NL80211_EXTERNAL_AUTH_ABORT,
6512};
6513
6514/**
6515 * enum nl80211_ftm_responder_attributes - fine timing measurement
6516 *	responder attributes
6517 * @__NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_INVALID: Invalid
6518 * @NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_ENABLED: FTM responder is enabled
6519 * @NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_LCI: The content of Measurement Report Element
6520 *	(9.4.2.22 in 802.11-2016) with type 8 - LCI (9.4.2.22.10),
6521 *	i.e. starting with the measurement token
6522 * @NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_CIVIC: The content of Measurement Report Element
6523 *	(9.4.2.22 in 802.11-2016) with type 11 - Civic (Section 9.4.2.22.13),
6524 *	i.e. starting with the measurement token
6525 * @__NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_LAST: Internal
6526 * @NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_MAX: highest FTM responder attribute.
6527 */
6528enum nl80211_ftm_responder_attributes {
6529	__NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_INVALID,
6530
6531	NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_ENABLED,
6532	NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_LCI,
6533	NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_CIVICLOC,
6534
6535	/* keep last */
6536	__NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_LAST,
6537	NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_LAST - 1,
6538};
6539
6540/*
6541 * enum nl80211_ftm_responder_stats - FTM responder statistics
6542 *
6543 * These attribute types are used with %NL80211_ATTR_FTM_RESPONDER_STATS
6544 * when getting FTM responder statistics.
6545 *
6546 * @__NL80211_FTM_STATS_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
6547 * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_SUCCESS_NUM: number of FTM sessions in which all frames
6548 *	were ssfully answered (u32)
6549 * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_PARTIAL_NUM: number of FTM sessions in which part of the
6550 *	frames were successfully answered (u32)
6551 * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_FAILED_NUM: number of failed FTM sessions (u32)
6552 * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_ASAP_NUM: number of ASAP sessions (u32)
6553 * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_NON_ASAP_NUM: number of non-ASAP sessions (u32)
6554 * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_TOTAL_DURATION_MSEC: total sessions durations - gives an
6555 *	indication of how much time the responder was busy (u64, msec)
6556 * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_UNKNOWN_TRIGGERS_NUM: number of unknown FTM triggers -
6557 *	triggers from initiators that didn't finish successfully the negotiation
6558 *	phase with the responder (u32)
6559 * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_RESCHEDULE_REQUESTS_NUM: number of FTM reschedule requests
6560 *	- initiator asks for a new scheduling although it already has scheduled
6561 *	FTM slot (u32)
6562 * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_OUT_OF_WINDOW_TRIGGERS_NUM: number of FTM triggers out of
6563 *	scheduled window (u32)
6564 * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_PAD: used for padding, ignore
6565 * @__NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: Internal
6566 * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_MAX: highest possible FTM responder stats attribute
6567 */
6568enum nl80211_ftm_responder_stats {
6569	__NL80211_FTM_STATS_INVALID,
6570	NL80211_FTM_STATS_SUCCESS_NUM,
6571	NL80211_FTM_STATS_PARTIAL_NUM,
6572	NL80211_FTM_STATS_FAILED_NUM,
6573	NL80211_FTM_STATS_ASAP_NUM,
6574	NL80211_FTM_STATS_NON_ASAP_NUM,
6575	NL80211_FTM_STATS_TOTAL_DURATION_MSEC,
6576	NL80211_FTM_STATS_UNKNOWN_TRIGGERS_NUM,
6577	NL80211_FTM_STATS_RESCHEDULE_REQUESTS_NUM,
6578	NL80211_FTM_STATS_OUT_OF_WINDOW_TRIGGERS_NUM,
6579	NL80211_FTM_STATS_PAD,
6580
6581	/* keep last */
6582	__NL80211_FTM_STATS_AFTER_LAST,
6583	NL80211_FTM_STATS_MAX = __NL80211_FTM_STATS_AFTER_LAST - 1
6584};
6585
6586/**
6587 * enum nl80211_preamble - frame preamble types
6588 * @NL80211_PREAMBLE_LEGACY: legacy (HR/DSSS, OFDM, ERP PHY) preamble
6589 * @NL80211_PREAMBLE_HT: HT preamble
6590 * @NL80211_PREAMBLE_VHT: VHT preamble
6591 * @NL80211_PREAMBLE_DMG: DMG preamble
6592 * @NL80211_PREAMBLE_HE: HE preamble
6593 */
6594enum nl80211_preamble {
6595	NL80211_PREAMBLE_LEGACY,
6596	NL80211_PREAMBLE_HT,
6597	NL80211_PREAMBLE_VHT,
6598	NL80211_PREAMBLE_DMG,
6599	NL80211_PREAMBLE_HE,
6600};
6601
6602/**
6603 * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_type - peer measurement types
6604 * @NL80211_PMSR_TYPE_INVALID: invalid/unused, needed as we use
6605 *	these numbers also for attributes
6606 *
6607 * @NL80211_PMSR_TYPE_FTM: flight time measurement
6608 *
6609 * @NUM_NL80211_PMSR_TYPES: internal
6610 * @NL80211_PMSR_TYPE_MAX: highest type number
6611 */
6612enum nl80211_peer_measurement_type {
6613	NL80211_PMSR_TYPE_INVALID,
6614
6615	NL80211_PMSR_TYPE_FTM,
6616
6617	NUM_NL80211_PMSR_TYPES,
6618	NL80211_PMSR_TYPE_MAX = NUM_NL80211_PMSR_TYPES - 1
6619};
6620
6621/**
6622 * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_status - peer measurement status
6623 * @NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_SUCCESS: measurement completed successfully
6624 * @NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_REFUSED: measurement was locally refused
6625 * @NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_TIMEOUT: measurement timed out
6626 * @NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_FAILURE: measurement failed, a type-dependent
6627 *	reason may be available in the response data
6628 */
6629enum nl80211_peer_measurement_status {
6630	NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_SUCCESS,
6631	NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_REFUSED,
6632	NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_TIMEOUT,
6633	NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_FAILURE,
6634};
6635
6636/**
6637 * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_req - peer measurement request attributes
6638 * @__NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTR_INVALID: invalid
6639 *
6640 * @NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTR_DATA: This is a nested attribute with measurement
6641 *	type-specific request data inside. The attributes used are from the
6642 *	enums named nl80211_peer_measurement_<type>_req.
6643 * @NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTR_GET_AP_TSF: include AP TSF timestamp, if supported
6644 *	(flag attribute)
6645 *
6646 * @NUM_NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTRS: internal
6647 * @NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute number
6648 */
6649enum nl80211_peer_measurement_req {
6650	__NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTR_INVALID,
6651
6652	NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTR_DATA,
6653	NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTR_GET_AP_TSF,
6654
6655	/* keep last */
6656	NUM_NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTRS,
6657	NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTRS - 1
6658};
6659
6660/**
6661 * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_resp - peer measurement response attributes
6662 * @__NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_INVALID: invalid
6663 *
6664 * @NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_DATA: This is a nested attribute with measurement
6665 *	type-specific results inside. The attributes used are from the enums
6666 *	named nl80211_peer_measurement_<type>_resp.
6667 * @NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_STATUS: u32 value with the measurement status
6668 *	(using values from &enum nl80211_peer_measurement_status.)
6669 * @NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_HOST_TIME: host time (%CLOCK_BOOTTIME) when the
6670 *	result was measured; this value is not expected to be accurate to
6671 *	more than 20ms. (u64, nanoseconds)
6672 * @NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_AP_TSF: TSF of the AP that the interface
6673 *	doing the measurement is connected to when the result was measured.
6674 *	This shall be accurately reported if supported and requested
6675 *	(u64, usec)
6676 * @NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_FINAL: If results are sent to the host partially
6677 *	(*e.g. with FTM per-burst data) this flag will be cleared on all but
6678 *	the last result; if all results are combined it's set on the single
6679 *	result.
6680 * @NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_PAD: padding for 64-bit attributes, ignore
6681 *
6682 * @NUM_NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTRS: internal
6683 * @NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute number
6684 */
6685enum nl80211_peer_measurement_resp {
6686	__NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_INVALID,
6687
6688	NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_DATA,
6689	NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_STATUS,
6690	NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_HOST_TIME,
6691	NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_AP_TSF,
6692	NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_FINAL,
6693	NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_PAD,
6694
6695	/* keep last */
6696	NUM_NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTRS,
6697	NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTRS - 1
6698};
6699
6700/**
6701 * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_peer_attrs - peer attributes for measurement
6702 * @__NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_INVALID: invalid
6703 *
6704 * @NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_ADDR: peer's MAC address
6705 * @NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_CHAN: channel definition, nested, using top-level
6706 *	attributes like %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ etc.
6707 * @NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_REQ: This is a nested attribute indexed by
6708 *	measurement type, with attributes from the
6709 *	&enum nl80211_peer_measurement_req inside.
6710 * @NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_RESP: This is a nested attribute indexed by
6711 *	measurement type, with attributes from the
6712 *	&enum nl80211_peer_measurement_resp inside.
6713 *
6714 * @NUM_NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTRS: internal
6715 * @NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute number
6716 */
6717enum nl80211_peer_measurement_peer_attrs {
6718	__NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_INVALID,
6719
6720	NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_ADDR,
6721	NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_CHAN,
6722	NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_REQ,
6723	NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_RESP,
6724
6725	/* keep last */
6726	NUM_NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTRS,
6727	NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTRS - 1,
6728};
6729
6730/**
6731 * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_attrs - peer measurement attributes
6732 * @__NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_INVALID: invalid
6733 *
6734 * @NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_MAX_PEERS: u32 attribute used for capability
6735 *	advertisement only, indicates the maximum number of peers
6736 *	measurements can be done with in a single request
6737 * @NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_REPORT_AP_TSF: flag attribute in capability
6738 *	indicating that the connected AP's TSF can be reported in
6739 *	measurement results
6740 * @NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_RANDOMIZE_MAC_ADDR: flag attribute in capability
6741 *	indicating that MAC address randomization is supported.
6742 * @NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_TYPE_CAPA: capabilities reported by the device,
6743 *	this contains a nesting indexed by measurement type, and
6744 *	type-specific capabilities inside, which are from the enums
6745 *	named nl80211_peer_measurement_<type>_capa.
6746 * @NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_PEERS: nested attribute, the nesting index is
6747 *	meaningless, just a list of peers to measure with, with the
6748 *	sub-attributes taken from
6749 *	&enum nl80211_peer_measurement_peer_attrs.
6750 *
6751 * @NUM_NL80211_PMSR_ATTR: internal
6752 * @NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute number
6753 */
6754enum nl80211_peer_measurement_attrs {
6755	__NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_INVALID,
6756
6757	NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_MAX_PEERS,
6758	NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_REPORT_AP_TSF,
6759	NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_RANDOMIZE_MAC_ADDR,
6760	NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_TYPE_CAPA,
6761	NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_PEERS,
6762
6763	/* keep last */
6764	NUM_NL80211_PMSR_ATTR,
6765	NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_PMSR_ATTR - 1
6766};
6767
6768/**
6769 * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_capa - FTM capabilities
6770 * @__NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_INVALID: invalid
6771 *
6772 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_ASAP: flag attribute indicating ASAP mode
6773 *	is supported
6774 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_NON_ASAP: flag attribute indicating non-ASAP
6775 *	mode is supported
6776 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_REQ_LCI: flag attribute indicating if LCI
6777 *	data can be requested during the measurement
6778 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_REQ_CIVICLOC: flag attribute indicating if civic
6779 *	location data can be requested during the measurement
6780 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_PREAMBLES: u32 bitmap attribute of bits
6781 *	from &enum nl80211_preamble.
6782 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_BANDWIDTHS: bitmap of values from
6783 *	&enum nl80211_chan_width indicating the supported channel
6784 *	bandwidths for FTM. Note that a higher channel bandwidth may be
6785 *	configured to allow for other measurements types with different
6786 *	bandwidth requirement in the same measurement.
6787 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_MAX_BURSTS_EXPONENT: u32 attribute indicating
6788 *	the maximum bursts exponent that can be used (if not present anything
6789 *	is valid)
6790 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_MAX_FTMS_PER_BURST: u32 attribute indicating
6791 *	the maximum FTMs per burst (if not present anything is valid)
6792 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_TRIGGER_BASED: flag attribute indicating if
6793 *	trigger based ranging measurement is supported
6794 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_NON_TRIGGER_BASED: flag attribute indicating
6795 *	if non trigger based ranging measurement is supported
6796 *
6797 * @NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR: internal
6798 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute number
6799 */
6800enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_capa {
6801	__NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_INVALID,
6802
6803	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_ASAP,
6804	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_NON_ASAP,
6805	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_REQ_LCI,
6806	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_REQ_CIVICLOC,
6807	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_PREAMBLES,
6808	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_BANDWIDTHS,
6809	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_MAX_BURSTS_EXPONENT,
6810	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_MAX_FTMS_PER_BURST,
6811	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_TRIGGER_BASED,
6812	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_NON_TRIGGER_BASED,
6813
6814	/* keep last */
6815	NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR,
6816	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR - 1
6817};
6818
6819/**
6820 * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_req - FTM request attributes
6821 * @__NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_INVALID: invalid
6822 *
6823 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_ASAP: ASAP mode requested (flag)
6824 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_PREAMBLE: preamble type (see
6825 *	&enum nl80211_preamble), optional for DMG (u32)
6826 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NUM_BURSTS_EXP: number of bursts exponent as in
6827 *	802.11-2016 9.4.2.168 "Fine Timing Measurement Parameters element"
6828 *	(u8, 0-15, optional with default 15 i.e. "no preference")
6829 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_BURST_PERIOD: interval between bursts in units
6830 *	of 100ms (u16, optional with default 0)
6831 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_BURST_DURATION: burst duration, as in 802.11-2016
6832 *	Table 9-257 "Burst Duration field encoding" (u8, 0-15, optional with
6833 *	default 15 i.e. "no preference")
6834 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_FTMS_PER_BURST: number of successful FTM frames
6835 *	requested per burst
6836 *	(u8, 0-31, optional with default 0 i.e. "no preference")
6837 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NUM_FTMR_RETRIES: number of FTMR frame retries
6838 *	(u8, default 3)
6839 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_REQUEST_LCI: request LCI data (flag)
6840 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_REQUEST_CIVICLOC: request civic location data
6841 *	(flag)
6842 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_TRIGGER_BASED: request trigger based ranging
6843 *	measurement (flag).
6844 *	This attribute and %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NON_TRIGGER_BASED are
6845 *	mutually exclusive.
6846 *      if neither %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_TRIGGER_BASED nor
6847 *	%NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NON_TRIGGER_BASED is set, EDCA based
6848 *	ranging will be used.
6849 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NON_TRIGGER_BASED: request non trigger based
6850 *	ranging measurement (flag)
6851 *	This attribute and %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_TRIGGER_BASED are
6852 *	mutually exclusive.
6853 *      if neither %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_TRIGGER_BASED nor
6854 *	%NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NON_TRIGGER_BASED is set, EDCA based
6855 *	ranging will be used.
6856 *
6857 * @NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR: internal
6858 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute number
6859 */
6860enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_req {
6861	__NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_INVALID,
6862
6863	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_ASAP,
6864	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_PREAMBLE,
6865	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NUM_BURSTS_EXP,
6866	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_BURST_PERIOD,
6867	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_BURST_DURATION,
6868	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_FTMS_PER_BURST,
6869	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NUM_FTMR_RETRIES,
6870	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_REQUEST_LCI,
6871	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_REQUEST_CIVICLOC,
6872	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_TRIGGER_BASED,
6873	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NON_TRIGGER_BASED,
6874
6875	/* keep last */
6876	NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR,
6877	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR - 1
6878};
6879
6880/**
6881 * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_failure_reasons - FTM failure reasons
6882 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_UNSPECIFIED: unspecified failure, not used
6883 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_NO_RESPONSE: no response from the FTM responder
6884 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_REJECTED: FTM responder rejected measurement
6885 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_WRONG_CHANNEL: we already know the peer is
6886 *	on a different channel, so can't measure (if we didn't know, we'd
6887 *	try and get no response)
6888 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_PEER_NOT_CAPABLE: peer can't actually do FTM
6889 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_INVALID_TIMESTAMP: invalid T1/T4 timestamps
6890 *	received
6891 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_PEER_BUSY: peer reports busy, you may retry
6892 *	later (see %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_BUSY_RETRY_TIME)
6893 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_BAD_CHANGED_PARAMS: parameters were changed
6894 *	by the peer and are no longer supported
6895 */
6896enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_failure_reasons {
6897	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_UNSPECIFIED,
6898	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_NO_RESPONSE,
6899	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_REJECTED,
6900	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_WRONG_CHANNEL,
6901	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_PEER_NOT_CAPABLE,
6902	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_INVALID_TIMESTAMP,
6903	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_PEER_BUSY,
6904	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_BAD_CHANGED_PARAMS,
6905};
6906
6907/**
6908 * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_resp - FTM response attributes
6909 * @__NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_INVALID: invalid
6910 *
6911 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_FAIL_REASON: FTM-specific failure reason
6912 *	(u32, optional)
6913 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_BURST_INDEX: optional, if bursts are reported
6914 *	as separate results then it will be the burst index 0...(N-1) and
6915 *	the top level will indicate partial results (u32)
6916 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_NUM_FTMR_ATTEMPTS: number of FTM Request frames
6917 *	transmitted (u32, optional)
6918 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_NUM_FTMR_SUCCESSES: number of FTM Request frames
6919 *	that were acknowleged (u32, optional)
6920 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_BUSY_RETRY_TIME: retry time received from the
6921 *	busy peer (u32, seconds)
6922 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_NUM_BURSTS_EXP: actual number of bursts exponent
6923 *	used by the responder (similar to request, u8)
6924 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_BURST_DURATION: actual burst duration used by
6925 *	the responder (similar to request, u8)
6926 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_FTMS_PER_BURST: actual FTMs per burst used
6927 *	by the responder (similar to request, u8)
6928 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RSSI_AVG: average RSSI across all FTM action
6929 *	frames (optional, s32, 1/2 dBm)
6930 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RSSI_SPREAD: RSSI spread across all FTM action
6931 *	frames (optional, s32, 1/2 dBm)
6932 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_TX_RATE: bitrate we used for the response to the
6933 *	FTM action frame (optional, nested, using &enum nl80211_rate_info
6934 *	attributes)
6935 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RX_RATE: bitrate the responder used for the FTM
6936 *	action frame (optional, nested, using &enum nl80211_rate_info attrs)
6937 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RTT_AVG: average RTT (s64, picoseconds, optional
6938 *	but one of RTT/DIST must be present)
6939 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RTT_VARIANCE: RTT variance (u64, ps^2, note that
6940 *	standard deviation is the square root of variance, optional)
6941 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RTT_SPREAD: RTT spread (u64, picoseconds,
6942 *	optional)
6943 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_DIST_AVG: average distance (s64, mm, optional
6944 *	but one of RTT/DIST must be present)
6945 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_DIST_VARIANCE: distance variance (u64, mm^2, note
6946 *	that standard deviation is the square root of variance, optional)
6947 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_DIST_SPREAD: distance spread (u64, mm, optional)
6948 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_LCI: LCI data from peer (binary, optional);
6949 *	this is the contents of the Measurement Report Element (802.11-2016
6950 *	9.4.2.22.1) starting with the Measurement Token, with Measurement
6951 *	Type 8.
6952 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_CIVICLOC: civic location data from peer
6953 *	(binary, optional);
6954 *	this is the contents of the Measurement Report Element (802.11-2016
6955 *	9.4.2.22.1) starting with the Measurement Token, with Measurement
6956 *	Type 11.
6957 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_PAD: ignore, for u64/s64 padding only
6958 *
6959 * @NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR: internal
6960 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute number
6961 */
6962enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_resp {
6963	__NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_INVALID,
6964
6965	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_FAIL_REASON,
6966	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_BURST_INDEX,
6967	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_NUM_FTMR_ATTEMPTS,
6968	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_NUM_FTMR_SUCCESSES,
6969	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_BUSY_RETRY_TIME,
6970	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_NUM_BURSTS_EXP,
6971	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_BURST_DURATION,
6972	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_FTMS_PER_BURST,
6973	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RSSI_AVG,
6974	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RSSI_SPREAD,
6975	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_TX_RATE,
6976	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RX_RATE,
6977	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RTT_AVG,
6978	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RTT_VARIANCE,
6979	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RTT_SPREAD,
6980	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_DIST_AVG,
6981	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_DIST_VARIANCE,
6982	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_DIST_SPREAD,
6983	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_LCI,
6984	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_CIVICLOC,
6985	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_PAD,
6986
6987	/* keep last */
6988	NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR,
6989	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR - 1
6990};
6991
6992/**
6993 * enum nl80211_obss_pd_attributes - OBSS packet detection attributes
6994 * @__NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_INVALID: Invalid
6995 *
6996 * @NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_MIN_OFFSET: the OBSS PD minimum tx power offset.
6997 * @NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_MAX_OFFSET: the OBSS PD maximum tx power offset.
6998 * @NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_NON_SRG_MAX_OFFSET: the non-SRG OBSS PD maximum
6999 *	tx power offset.
7000 * @NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_BSS_COLOR_BITMAP: bitmap that indicates the BSS color
7001 *	values used by members of the SRG.
7002 * @NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_PARTIAL_BSSID_BITMAP: bitmap that indicates the partial
7003 *	BSSID values used by members of the SRG.
7004 * @NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_SR_CTRL: The SR Control field of SRP element.
7005 *
7006 * @__NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_LAST: Internal
7007 * @NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_MAX: highest OBSS PD attribute.
7008 */
7009enum nl80211_obss_pd_attributes {
7010	__NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_INVALID,
7011
7012	NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_MIN_OFFSET,
7013	NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_MAX_OFFSET,
7014	NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_NON_SRG_MAX_OFFSET,
7015	NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_BSS_COLOR_BITMAP,
7016	NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_PARTIAL_BSSID_BITMAP,
7017	NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_SR_CTRL,
7018
7019	/* keep last */
7020	__NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_LAST,
7021	NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_LAST - 1,
7022};
7023
7024/**
7025 * enum nl80211_bss_color_attributes - BSS Color attributes
7026 * @__NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_INVALID: Invalid
7027 *
7028 * @NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_COLOR: the current BSS Color.
7029 * @NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_DISABLED: is BSS coloring disabled.
7030 * @NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_PARTIAL: the AID equation to be used..
7031 *
7032 * @__NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_LAST: Internal
7033 * @NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_MAX: highest BSS Color attribute.
7034 */
7035enum nl80211_bss_color_attributes {
7036	__NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_INVALID,
7037
7038	NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_COLOR,
7039	NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_DISABLED,
7040	NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_PARTIAL,
7041
7042	/* keep last */
7043	__NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_LAST,
7044	NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_LAST - 1,
7045};
7046
7047/**
7048 * enum nl80211_iftype_akm_attributes - interface type AKM attributes
7049 * @__NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_INVALID: Invalid
7050 *
7051 * @NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_IFTYPES: nested attribute containing a flag
7052 *	attribute for each interface type that supports AKM suites specified in
7053 *	%NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_SUITES
7054 * @NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_SUITES: an array of u32. Used to indicate supported
7055 *	AKM suites for the specified interface types.
7056 *
7057 * @__NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_LAST: Internal
7058 * @NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_MAX: highest interface type AKM attribute.
7059 */
7060enum nl80211_iftype_akm_attributes {
7061	__NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_INVALID,
7062
7063	NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_IFTYPES,
7064	NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_SUITES,
7065
7066	/* keep last */
7067	__NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_LAST,
7068	NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_LAST - 1,
7069};
7070
7071/**
7072 * enum nl80211_fils_discovery_attributes - FILS discovery configuration
7073 * from IEEE Std 802.11ai-2016, Annex C.3 MIB detail.
7074 *
7075 * @__NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_INVALID: Invalid
7076 *
7077 * @NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_INT_MIN: Minimum packet interval (u32, TU).
7078 *	Allowed range: 0..10000 (TU = Time Unit)
7079 * @NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_INT_MAX: Maximum packet interval (u32, TU).
7080 *	Allowed range: 0..10000 (TU = Time Unit)
7081 * @NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_TMPL: Template data for FILS discovery action
7082 *	frame including the headers.
7083 *
7084 * @__NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_LAST: Internal
7085 * @NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute
7086 */
7087enum nl80211_fils_discovery_attributes {
7088	__NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_INVALID,
7089
7090	NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_INT_MIN,
7091	NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_INT_MAX,
7092	NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_TMPL,
7093
7094	/* keep last */
7095	__NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_LAST,
7096	NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_LAST - 1
7097};
7098
7099/*
7100 * FILS discovery template minimum length with action frame headers and
7101 * mandatory fields.
7102 */
7103#define NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_TMPL_MIN_LEN 42
7104
7105/**
7106 * enum nl80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp_attributes - Unsolicited broadcast probe
7107 *	response configuration. Applicable only in 6GHz.
7108 *
7109 * @__NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_INVALID: Invalid
7110 *
7111 * @NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_INT: Maximum packet interval (u32, TU).
7112 *	Allowed range: 0..20 (TU = Time Unit). IEEE P802.11ax/D6.0
7113 *	26.17.2.3.2 (AP behavior for fast passive scanning).
7114 * @NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_TMPL: Unsolicited broadcast probe response
7115 *	frame template (binary).
7116 *
7117 * @__NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_LAST: Internal
7118 * @NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute
7119 */
7120enum nl80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp_attributes {
7121	__NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_INVALID,
7122
7123	NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_INT,
7124	NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_TMPL,
7125
7126	/* keep last */
7127	__NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_LAST,
7128	NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_MAX =
7129		__NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_LAST - 1
7130};
7131#endif /* __LINUX_NL80211_H */
7132